Catalog IC 10 English 2011
Transcription
Catalog IC 10 English 2011
© Siemens AG 2010 Commanding and Signaling Devices 10/2 10/4 10/7 10/9 10/11 10/13 10/17 10/18 10/20 10/25 10/31 10/34 10/42 10/44 10/48 10/53 10/63 10/67 10/68 10/69 10/70 10/71 10/73 10/78 10/79 10/81 10/83 10/86 10/87 10/89 10/90 10/91 10/93 10/95 Introduction 3SB2 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 16 mm General data Complete units Actuators and indicators Contact blocks and lampholders Accessories and Spare Parts Insert labels and insert caps Name plates Mounting parts and components 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm General data Actuators and Indicators, Plastic, Round, 22 mm Complete units Coordinate switches, complete Actuators and indicators Actuators and Indicators, Plastic, Square, 26 mm × 26 mm Complete units Actuators and indicators Actuators and Indicators, Metal, Round, 22 mm Complete units Actuators and indicators Components for Actuators and Indicators Contact blocks and lampholders AS-Interface F adapters for EMERGENCY-STOP devices Special locks Inscriptions Laser inscriptions Inscriptions by laser printer Insert labels Name plates Accessories and Spare Parts Buttons and lenses Lamps, acoustic signal transformers and keys Protective covers Miscellaneous accessories Enclosures General data Enclosures with standard fittings Empty enclosures Customer-specific enclosures Contact blocks and lampholders Inscription labels for enclosures Accessories for enclosures Enclosures for AS-Interface General data AS-Interface enclosures with standard fittings 10/98 Components for AS-Interface enclosures IK PI1) Enclosures and Front Panel Modules for AS-Interface 10/96 10/97 10/99 3SB3 Two-Hand Operation Consoles Plastic and metal enclosures 3SE7, 3SF2 Cable-Operated Switches 10/100 3SE7 metal enclosures 10/104 3SF2 cable-operated switches for AS-Interface 3SE2, 3SE3 Foot Switches 10/105 Plastic and metal enclosures 8WD4 Signaling Columns 10/107 General data 10/110 8WD42 signaling columns, 50 mm diameter 10/112 8WD44 signaling columns, 70 mm diameter 8WD5 Integrated Signal Lamps 10/115 8WD53 integrated signal lamps, 70 mm diameter More technical information can be found at www.siemens.com/industrialcontrols/support under Product List: - Technical specifications under Entry List: - Updates - Downloads - FAQ - Manuals - Characteristics - Certificates and at www.siemens.com/industrialcontrols/configurators - Configurators 1) See Catalog IK PI. Siemens Siemens IC 10 IC· 10 2011 · 2011 10 Price Groups PG 101, 102, 121 10 © Siemens AG 2010 Commanding and Signaling Devices Introduction ■ Overview 3SB2 3SB30, 3SB32 3SB31, 3SB33 3SB35, 3SB36 16 mm Plastic, round 22 mm Plastic, round 26 mm × 26 mm Plastic, square 22 mm Metal, round ✓1) ✓1) --✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ --✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ---- ✓ ✓ ✓ ---- ---- ✓ -- ✓ ✓ ✓ -- ✓ -- ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ --- ✓ (with solder connections) ✓ ✓ ✓ (with solder connections) ✓ ✓ ✓ (with solder connections) ✓ ✓ ✓ --✓ -- -✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ -✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ -✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ Pushbuttons and indicator lights Designs Nominal diameter Version Actuators Pushbuttons and switches Illuminated pushbuttons and switches Mushroom pushbuttons Push-pull buttons EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbuttons Selector switches Key-operated switches Special actuators Coordinate switches Twin pushbuttons Potentiometer drives Indicators Indicator lights Acoustic signaling devices Contact blocks Single-pole Two-pole 10 Lampholders Wedge bases BA 9s bases With integrated LED Connections Plug-in connection Screw terminals Spring-type terminals Solder pins AS-Interface AS-Interface solutions ✓ Standard Commanding and signaling devices of the SIRIUS 3SB3 series can be connected to the AS-Interface communication system quickly and easily with the help of various solutions. -- Not available ❏ Optional 1) Only pushbuttons, no pushbutton switches. For AS-Interface solutions, see catalog IK PI "Industrial Communication for Automation & Drives". AS-Interface front panel modules AS-Interface EMERGENCY-STOP according to ISO 13850 The front panel module has one 4I/4O slave for connection of four 3SB3 commanding or signaling devices (see Catalog IK PI). Using a special F adapter, EMERGENCY-STOP devices according to ISO 13850 (former EN 418) can be directly connected through the standard AS-Interface with safety-oriented communication (see page 10/68). AS-Interface enclosures Enclosures with standard fittings are listed in this catalog. For customized enclosures, use the 3SB configurator to select the elements for equipping (see page 10/96). 10/2 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 Note: For safety characteristics see "Appendix" --> "Standards and approvals" --> "Overview" © Siemens AG 2010 Commanding and Signaling Devices Introduction 3SB38 3SB38 6 3SE7, 3SF2 3SE29 Enclosures Two-hand operation consoles Cable-operated switches Foot switches ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ -✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ❏ ✓ ✓ ---✓ ✓ ----- ✓ ✓ -- ❏ ❏ -- --✓ ---- ✓ ✓ ❏ ❏ ✓ -- --- ✓ ---- ✓ ✓ --- -✓ -✓ -✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ -❏ ✓ ✓ ❏ -❏ ❏ ✓ --❏ ✓ ✓ -✓ ❏ -- 8WD42, 8WD44 8WD53 Signaling columns Integrated signal lamps ✓ -- ✓ -- ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ --- Enclosures Plastic Metal Actuators Pushbuttons and switches Illuminated pushbuttons and switches Mushroom pushbuttons Push-pull buttons EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbuttons Selector switches Key-operated switches Bowden wires Indicators Indicator lights Acoustic signaling devices Contact blocks Single-pole Two-pole Three-pole Four-pole Screw terminals Spring-type terminals Molded cables Plug-in connection AS-Interface 10 Connections Enclosures Plastic Metal Lighting Incandescent lamps LEDs Flashlights Connections Screw terminals Spring-type terminals AS-Interface Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/3 © Siemens AG 2010 3SB2 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 16 mm General data For PCB mounting ■ Overview The 3SB2 pushbuttons and indicator lights are provided for front plate mounting and rear connection with flat connectors. For use on printed circuit boards, contact blocks and lampholders with solder pins are also available. For use on printed circuit boards, special contact blocks and lampholders for soldering into the printed circuit board are available. For this purpose, the contact blocks and lampholders are fitted with 0.8 mm × 0.8 mm solder pins of length 3.5 mm. F Standards IEC 60947-1, EN 60947-1, IEC 60947-5-1, EN 60947-5-1, IEC 60947-5-5, EN 60947-5-5 for EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbuttons. C D E B Version with flat connector A G G D C1 G NSD0_00010b F1 Actuator Front panel Spacer Holder Lampholder/ actuator F PCB A B C D E A1 F2 E D C1 A2 Connection methods B1 E D NSD0_00001b 10 A3 Flat connectors Solder pin connections C2 B2 F2 The terminals are indicated in the corresponding tables by the symbols shown on orange backgrounds. ■ Application A1 Button, flat A2 Illuminated button, flat A3 Screw lens for indicator light B1 Insert label, for labeling B2 Insert cap, for labeling C1 C2 D E Collar with extruded front ring Collar for indicator light Frame for rectangular design Wedge base lamp, W2 x 4.6d F1 Holders F2 Lampholder with holder G Contact block for snapping onto the holder and/or onto the lampholder(1NO or 1NC) 10/4 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 The devices are climate-proof and suitable for marine applications. Safety EMERGENCY-STOP pushbuttons according to ISO 13850 For controls according to IEC 60204-1 or EN 60204-1 (VDE 0113 Part 1), the mushroom pushbuttons of the 3SB2 series are suitable for use as safety EMERGENCY-STOP pushbuttons. Safety circuits IEC 60947-5-1 and EN 60947-5-1 require positive opening, i.e. for the purposes of personal safety, the assured opening of NC contacts is expressly stipulated for the electrical equipment of machines in all safety circuits and marked according to IEC 60947-5-1 with the symbol . Category 4 according to EN 954-1 can be attained with the EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbuttons if the corresponding failsafe evaluation units are selected and correctly installed, e.g. the 3TK28 safety relays or matching units from the ASIsafe, SIMATIC or SINUMERIK product ranges. © Siemens AG 2010 3SB2 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 16 mm General data ■ Technical specifications Type 3SB2 Contact blocks and lampholders Standards Rated insulation voltage Ui IEC 60947-5-1, EN 60947-5-1 IEC 60947-5-5, EN 60947-5-5 V 250 Conventional thermal current Ith A 10 • Alternating current AC-12 - At Ue = 24 ... 230 V A 10 • Alternating current AC-15 - At Ue = 24 ... 230 V A 4 • Direct current DC-12 - At Ue = 24 V - At Ue = 60 V - At Ue = 110 V - At Ue = 230 V A A A A 6 5 2.5 1 • Direct current DC-13 - At Ue = 24 V - At Ue = 60 V - At Ue = 110 V - At Ue = 230 V A A A A 3 1.5 0.7 0.3 Rated operational current Ie at rated operational voltage Ue Contact stability • Test voltage/test current Lamps • Bases • Rated voltage • Rated power, max. 5 V / 1 mA V W Wedge base W2 × 4.6 d 6, 12, 24, 30, 48, 60 1 Short-circuit protection weld-free acc. to IEC 60947-5-1 • DIAZED fuse links, utilization category gG • Miniature circuit breaker with C characteristic acc. to IEC 60898 10 A TDz, 16 A Dz 10 A Electrical endurance • For utilization category AC-15 with 3RT10 15 to 3RT10 26 contactors 10 × 106 operating cycles Mechanical endurance 10 × 106 operating cycles Degree of protection acc. to IEC 60529 • Connection of contact blocks and lampholders behind the front panel • Contact chambers of the contact blocks behind the front panel IP00 IP40 Finger-safe acc. to EN 61140 and BGV A3 With voltages > 50 V AC or 120 V DC, insulation sleeves must be fitted to the unassigned tab connections. V V 250 AC 60; 1 W Uninterrupted current A 5 Switching capacity 10 Data according to UL and CSA Rated voltage • Contact blocks • Indicator light (lamp with wedge base W2 × 4.6 d) B 300, R 300 Actuators and indicators Mechanical endurance • Pushbuttons • Actuators, rotary or latching • Illuminated pushbuttons 10 × 106 operating cycles 3 × 105 operating cycles 3 × 106 operating cycles Climatic withstand capability Climate-proof; suitable for marine applications Ambient temperature • During operation, non-illuminated devices and complete with LED • During operation, devices with incandescent lamp • During storage, transport °C °C °C Degree of protection acc. to IEC 60529 • Actuators and indicators • Actuators and indicators with protective cap IP65 IP67 Protective measures • For mounting in metal front plates and enclosures The actuators and lens assemblies must not be included in the protective measures. The protective measure "Total insulation" is retained. • For fitting into enclosures with total insulation Shock resistance acc. to IEC 60068-2-27 • Shock amplitude • Shock duration • Shock form –25 ... +70 –25 ... +60 –40 ... +80 ms ≤ 50 g 11 Half-sine For further technical information, see page 10/1. Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/5 © Siemens AG 2010 3SB2 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 16 mm General data Configuration For PCB mounting Design The command point comprises the actuator – e.g. 3SB2 pushbutton, illuminated pushbutton or indicator light –, which is mounted in the front plate, and a contact block and a lampholder which are soldered to the PCB. For this purpose, the contact blocks and lampholders are fitted with 0.8 mm × 0.8 mm solder pins of length 3.5 mm. Mounting and fixing: Mounting dimensions according to EN 50007 (not applicable to EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbuttons) +0,2 Mounting dimensions according to EN 50007. The actuators are mounted in the same way as 3SB2 front plate mounting devices. The contact blocks and lampholders are plugged into the printed circuit board by means of their solder pins and can be flow-soldered. After soldering, the devices must be flush with the board and perpendicular to it. The printed circuit board must be supported on spacing bolts so that it cannot sag or bend more than 0.1 mm. 1...6 1,5...2,5 44-0,2 20,2 a Minimum clearance a b Round version 19 19 Square version without inscription label 21 21 Round and square version with inscription label 21 32 For 2 selector switches with 3 switch positions, latching, side by side 21 21 Length a of spacing bolts: a = 44-0.2 minus front plate thickness. When using name plates, the length a is reduced by 0.8 mm. NSD0_00011a 19 Illuminated pushbutton with solder pin connection To avoid bending the PCB when the pushbuttons are operated, sufficient spacing bolts must be provided as shown in the table below: PCB thickness Max. distance between spacing bolts 1.5 mm 80 mm 2.5 mm 150 mm One or two contact blocks can be mounted on the holder. They are inserted into the holder with slide slots and held down with two snap brackets. These details are based on epoxy resin glass fiber mat. When using EMERGENCY-STOP pushbuttons Always 50 mm 7,6 50 Solder pin spacing 19 Pushbutton (flat) with holder and contact block If a command point is fitted with an indicator light or illuminated pushbutton, a lamp socket with lampholder must be used instead of a holder. It is suitable for incandescent lamps or LEDs with bases of type W2 × 4.6d. 10/6 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 NO, NC La NO, NC NSD0_00012a Solder terminal Ø1.3+0,1 12,7 Ø4,2 10,16 8 Ø19 1...6 For mounting, the actuator or the lens assembly is inserted from the front into the hole in the front plate. Four small nubs ensure a secure fitting in the hole. The holder is plugged on from the side and snaps automatically into place. The module is fixed to the holder with 2 screws so that it is immune to vibrations. NSD0_00140a 10 a NSD0_00002a b 16,2 Mounting and fixing: a Two design versions can be mounted: • Round design: The 3SB2 pushbuttons and indicator lights are assembled with the modules – actuator, holder, contact block and lampholder. Depending on the specific application, various versions can be assembled. Complete units are offered for the most commonly used applications. • Square design: With square, black frames the round units can be given a square look. The frames are inserted underneath the round actuators. Further mounting is the same as for the round version. © Siemens AG 2010 3SB2 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 16 mm Complete units ■ Selection and ordering data Version Contact blocks Color of handle DT Flat connectors Order No. Illuminated pushbutton with raised button PS* PG Price per PU Pushbuttons with flat button 1 NO 1 NC 1 NC 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO Black Black Red Yellow Green Blue White Clear1) } B } B } B } B 3SB2202-0AB01 3SB2203-0AB01 3SB2203-0AC01 3SB2202-0AD01 3SB2202-0AE01 3SB2202-0AF01 3SB2202-0AG01 3SB2202-0AH01 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 102 102 Illuminated pushbuttons with flat button Lampholder W2 x 4.6 d2) 1 NC 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO Red Yellow1) Green Blue Clear1) } B } B } 3SB2207-0AC01 3SB2206-0AD01 3SB2206-0AE01 3SB2206-0AF01 3SB2206-0AH01 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 Illuminated pushbuttons with flat button Lampholder W2 x 4.6 d with incandescent lamp 24 V 1 NC 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO Red Yellow1) Green Blue Clear1) } B } B } 3SB2227-0AC01 3SB2226-0AD01 3SB2226-0AE01 3SB2226-0AF01 3SB2226-0AH01 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 Pushbuttons with raised button 1 NO 1 NC 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO Black Red Yellow Blue Clear1) B B B B B 3SB2202-0LB01 3SB2203-0LC01 3SB2202-0LD01 3SB2202-0LF01 3SB2202-0LH01 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 Illuminated pushbuttons with raised button Lampholder W2 x 4.6 d2) 1 NC 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO Red Yellow1) Green Blue Clear1) B B B B B 3SB2207-0LC01 3SB2206-0LD01 3SB2206-0LE01 3SB2206-0LF01 3SB2206-0LH01 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 Illuminated pushbuttons with raised button Lampholder W2 x 4.6 d with incandescent lamp 24 V 1 NC 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO Red Yellow1) Green Blue Clear1) B B B B B 3SB2227-0LC01 3SB2226-0LD01 3SB2226-0LE01 3SB2226-0LF01 3SB2226-0LH01 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 Red } 3SB2203-1AC01 1 1 unit 102 EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom 1 NC pushbuttons 3) acc. to ISO 13850, latching Latches automatically when pressed; unlatches by turning the mushroom head anticlockwise, with yellow name plate, with inscription "NOT-HALT" 4) 10 Pushbutton with flat button PU (UNIT, SET, M) EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbutton 1) Inscription is possible by inserting a label. 2) For wedge base lamps, see Accessories. 3) The mushroom pushbutton cannot be combined with 3SB29 02-0AB name plate or 3SB29 02-0AA single frame. 4) Positive opening according to IEC 60947-5-1, Appendix K. * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/7 © Siemens AG 2010 3SB2 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 16 mm Complete units Version Contact blocks Color of handle DT Flat connectors Order No. Selector switch PG Price per PU 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO Black Red Green White } B B B 3SB2202-2AB01 3SB2202-2AC01 3SB2202-2AE01 3SB2202-2AG01 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 Selector switches, 3 switch positions Switching sequence I-O-II, 2 × 62° operating angle, latching 1 NO, 1 NO 1 NO, 1 NO 1 NO, 1 NO 1 NO, 1 NO Black Red Green White } B B B 3SB2210-2DB01 3SB2210-2DC01 3SB2210-2DE01 3SB2210-2DG01 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 Selector switches, 3 switch positions Switching sequence I-O-II, 2 × 50° operating angle, momentary contact type 1 NO, 1 NO 1 NO, 1 NO 1 NO, 1 NO 1 NO, 1 NO Black Red Green White } B B B 3SB2210-2EB01 3SB2210-2EC01 3SB2210-2EE01 3SB2210-2EG01 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 Key removal position DT Flat connectors PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG Contact blocks Lock No. Order No. CES key-operated switches, 1 NO 2 switch positions 1 NO Switching sequence O-I, 62° operating angle, latching 10 PS* Selector switches, 2 switch positions Switching sequence O-I, 62° operating angle, latching Version SB2 SB2 CES key-operated switches, 1 NO, 1 NO SB2 3 switch positions 1 NO, 1 NO SB2 Switching sequence I-O-II, 2 × 62° operating angle, CES key-operated switch latching CES key-operated switches, 1 NO, 1 NO SB2 3 switch positions Switching sequence I-O-II, 2 × 50° operating angle, momentary contact type Version Color of screw lens Price per PU O O+I } B 3SB2202-4LA01 3SB2202-4LB01 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 O I + O + II B B 3SB2210-4PA01 3SB2210-4PB01 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 O B 3SB2210-4QA01 1 1 unit 102 DT Flat connectors PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG Order No. Price per PU Indicator lights Lampholder W2 x 4.6 d without lamp1) Red Yellow Green White Clear } B } } B 3SB2204-6BC06 3SB2204-6BD06 3SB2204-6BE06 3SB2204-6BG06 3SB2204-6BH06 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 Indicator lights Lampholder W2 x 4.6 d with incandescent lamp 24 V Red Yellow Green White Clear } B } } B 3SB2224-6BC06 3SB2224-6BD06 3SB2224-6BE06 3SB2224-6BG06 3SB2224-6BH06 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 Indicator light 1) PU (UNIT, SET, M) For wedge base lamps, see Accessories. 10/8 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate © Siemens AG 2010 3SB2 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 16 mm Actuators and indicators ■ Selection and ordering data Version Color of handle DT Order No. Pushbuttons with flat button Black Red Yellow Green Blue White Clear1) } } B } A } B Illuminated pushbuttons with flat button Red Yellow1) Green Blue White Clear1) Pushbuttons with raised button Price per PU PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG 3SB2000-0AB01 3SB2000-0AC01 3SB2000-0AD01 3SB2000-0AE01 3SB2000-0AF01 3SB2000-0AG01 3SB2000-0AH01 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 102 } B } B } B 3SB2001-0AC01 3SB2001-0AD01 3SB2001-0AE01 3SB2001-0AF01 3SB2000-0AG01 3SB2000-0AH01 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 Black Red Yellow Blue White Clear1) B B B B B B 3SB2000-0LB01 3SB2000-0LC01 3SB2000-0LD01 3SB2000-0LF01 3SB2000-0LG01 3SB2000-0LH01 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 Illuminated pushbuttons with raised button Red Yellow1) Green Blue Clear1) B B A B B 3SB2001-0LC01 3SB2001-0LD01 3SB2001-0LE01 3SB2001-0LF01 3SB2000-0LH01 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbuttons acc. to ISO 13850, latching2) Latches automatically when pressed; unlatches by turning the mushroom head anticlockwise Red } 3SB2000-1AC01 1 1 unit 102 Pushbuttons Pushbutton and illuminated pushbutton with flat button Pushbutton and illuminated pushbutton with raised button 1) Inscription is possible by inserting a label. 2) The mushroom pushbutton cannot be combined with 3SB29 02-0AB name plate or 3SB29 02-0AA single frame. Version Color of handle DT Order No. Selector switches with 2 switch positions Switching sequence O-I, 62° operating angle, latching Black Red Green White } B B B Selector switches with 2 switch positions Switching sequence O-I, 50° operating angle, momentary contact type (reset from the right) Black Red Green Selector switches with 2 switch positions Switching sequence O-I, 90° operating angle, latching Price per PU PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG 3SB2000-2AB01 3SB2000-2AC01 3SB2000-2AE01 3SB2000-2AG01 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 C B B 3SB2000-2BB01 3SB2000-2BC01 3SB2000-2BE01 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 Black Red Green White B B B B 3SB2000-2HB01 3SB2000-2HC01 3SB2000-2HE01 3SB2000-2HG01 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 Selector switches with 3 switch positions Switching sequence I-O-II, 2 x 62° operating angle, latching Black Red Green White } B B B 3SB2000-2DB01 3SB2000-2DC01 3SB2000-2DE01 3SB2000-2DG01 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 Selector switches with 3 switch positions Switching sequence I-O-II, 2 x 50° operating angle, momentary contact type Black Red Green White } B B B 3SB2000-2EB01 3SB2000-2EC01 3SB2000-2EE01 3SB2000-2EG01 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 Selector switches with 3 switch positions Switching sequence I-O-II, 2 x 90° operating angle, latching Black B 3SB2000-2JB01 1 1 unit 102 Selector switches Selector switch * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/9 10 EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbutton © Siemens AG 2010 3SB2 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 16 mm Actuators and indicators Version Lock No. Key removal position DT Order No. CES key-operated switches with 2 keys, 2 switch positions Switching sequence O-I, 62° operating angle, latching SB2 O+I O B } CES key-operated switches with 2 keys, 2 switch positions Switching sequence O-I, 50° operating angle, CES key-operated switch momentary contact CES key-operated switches with 2 keys, 3 switch positions Switching sequence I-O-II, 2 x 62° operating angle, latching SB2 O SB2 CES key-operated switches with 2 keys, 3 switch positions Switching sequence I-O-II, 2 x 50° operating angle, momentary contact SB2 Version Color of screw lens DT Order No. Indicator lights with concentric rings (inscription by inserting a cap is not possible) Red Yellow Green Blue White Clear } B } B } B Indicator lights, smooth for inscription by inserting a cap1) Red Yellow Green Blue Clear B B B B B Price per PU PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG 3SB2000-4LB01 3SB2000-4LA01 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 } 3SB2000-4MA01 1 1 unit 102 I+O+II O B B 3SB2000-4PB01 3SB2000-4PA01 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 O B 3SB2000-4QA01 1 1 unit 102 PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG 3SB2001-6BC06 3SB2001-6BD06 3SB2001-6BE06 3SB2001-6BF06 3SB2001-6BG06 3SB2001-6BH06 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 3SB2001-6CC06 3SB2001-6CD06 3SB2001-6CE06 3SB2001-6CF06 3SB2001-6CH06 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 Key-operated switches Price per PU Indicator lights 10 Indicator light 1) For insert caps, see Accessories. 10/10 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate © Siemens AG 2010 3SB2 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 16 mm Contact blocks and lampholders ■ Selection and ordering data Version Diagram DT Flat connectors Operating travel Contact closed PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG 1 5 units 102 Contact open Order No. Price per PU Contact blocks and lampholders with flat connectors 2 × 2.8 – 0.8 mm according to IEC 60760 Holders for fixing the actuator and the contact blocks } Holders for 2 contact blocks Inscription with identification number 1-2 3SB2908-0AA Holder Lampholders with holder for fixing the actuator and the contact blocks Lampholders W2 x 4.6 d without lamp X1 (L+) Lampholders W2 x 4.6 d X1 (L+) X2 (L-) } 3SB2304-2A 1 1 unit 102 NSD00003 X2 (L-) NSD00003 • With 6 V incandescent lamp • With 24 V incandescent lamp B 3SB2304-2F 1 1 unit 102 B 3SB2304-2H 1 1 unit 102 B 3SB2404-3D 1 1 unit 102 } 3SB2404-0B 1 1 unit 102 } 3SB2404-0C 1 1 unit 102 Lampholder Voltage reducers1) For connecting the 3SB29 08-1AE lamp (48 V) to 230 V AC X 1 X 2 N S D 0 _ 0 0 0 5 a Voltage reducer 10 Contact blocks for fixing in the holder or lampholder 1 NO 3 NSD00006 Contact blocks with one contact2) NSD00008 3-4 0 1 mm 4 3) 1 2 1) Use fixpoint terminal according to IEC 60439-1. 2) For plug-in and insulation sleeves, see Accessories. 3) Positive opening according to IEC 60947-5-1, Appendix K. * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate 3 4 NSD00009 NSD00007 1 NC Contact block 2 1-2 0 1 mm 2 3 4 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/11 © Siemens AG 2010 3SB2 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 16 mm Contact blocks and lampholders Version Diagram DT Solder pin connections Operating travel Contact closed PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG Contact open NSD0_00015 3-4 0 1 mm Contact blocks and lampholders with solder pins Lampholders Wedge base W2 x 4.6 d1) (L+) X1 3 Order No. 4 2,3 NSD00013 Holders for contact block with solder pins For fixing the actuators in the front panel 2 Price per PU C 3SB2908-0AB 1 5 units 102 B 3SB2455-2A 1 1 unit 102 B 3SB2455-0B 1 1 unit 102 B 3SB2455-0C 1 1 unit 102 B 3SB2455-0J 1 1 unit 102 B 3SB2455-0E 1 1 unit 102 B 3SB2455-0F 1 1 unit 102 B 3SB2455-1B 1 1 unit 102 B 3SB2455-1C 1 1 unit 102 B 3SB2455-1J 1 1 unit 102 B 3SB2455-1E 1 1 unit 102 B 3SB2455-1F 1 1 unit 102 (L-) X2 Holder Contact blocks 3 NSD0_00015 NSD00006 1 NO 3-4 0 1 mm 4 1 2 Contact block with solder pins 1 NO + 1 NC 2) 3 4 2,3 NSD0_00017 1-2 0 1 mm 13 21 2 3 4 1,6 NSD00019 NSD00018 2) NSD00007 1 NC 2 21-22 13-14 0 1 mm 14 22 2 3 4 13 23 NSD00020 1,6 1 NO + 1 NO NSD00021 13-14 23-24 0 1 mm 14 24 2 3 4 2,3 2) 11 21 NSD00023 NSD00022 1 NC + 1 NC 21-22 11-12 0 1 mm 10 12 22 2 3 4 1,6 1 NO 13 X1 NSD00024 Contact blocks and lampholders, wedge base W2 x 4.6 d1) NSD01082 13-14 0 1 mm 1 NC Contact block and lampholder with solder pins 2) 21 X1 22 X2 NSD00025 14 X2 2 3 4 2,3 NSD01083 21-22 0 1 mm 2 3 4 1,6 1 NO + 1 NC 2) 13 21 X1 NSD00019 21-22 13-14 0 1 mm 14 22 X2 2 3 4 1,6 1 NO + 1 NO 13 23 X1 NSD00021 13-14 23-24 0 1 mm 14 24 X2 2 3 4 2,3 1 NC + 1 NC 2) NSD00023 11 21 X1 21-22 11-12 12 22 X2 0 1 mm 2 3 4 1,6 1) The lamp is not included in the scope of supply. 2) Positive opening according to IEC 60947-5-1, Appendix K. 10/12 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate © Siemens AG 2010 3SB2 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 16 mm Accessories and Spare Parts Insert labels and insert caps ■ Overview Clear pushbuttons, illuminated pushbuttons and indicator lights can be fitted with insert labels and caps for identification purposes. The insert labels and insert caps are made of a milkytransparent plastic with black lettering; they can be fitted in any 90° angle. Inscriptions The inscriptions have upper case initial letters. Graphic symbols, including those not listed in the catalog, are according to ISO 7000 or IEC 60417. For customized inscriptions, see "Options". ■ Selection and ordering data Inscription/Symbol Symbol No. DT Insert labels For pushbuttons and illuminated pushbuttons, flat Order No. PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG Price per PU For self-inscription Blank B 3SB2901-4AA 100 10 units 102 Ein Aus Auf Ab B B B B 3SB2901-4AB 3SB2901-4AC 3SB2901-4AD 3SB2901-4AE 100 100 100 100 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 102 102 102 102 Vor Zurück Rechts Links B B B B 3SB2901-4AF 3SB2901-4AG 3SB2901-4AH 3SB2901-4AJ 100 100 100 100 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 102 102 102 102 Halt Zu Langsam Störung B B B B 3SB2901-4AK 3SB2901-4AL 3SB2901-4AN 3SB2901-4AQ 100 100 100 100 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 102 102 102 102 On Start Stop Reset Test B B B B B 3SB2901-4EB 3SB2901-4EK 3SB2901-4EL 3SB2901-4EM 3SB2901-4EN 100 100 100 100 100 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 102 102 102 102 102 0 1 2 3 4 B B B B B 3SB2901-4RA 3SB2901-4RB 3SB2901-4RC 3SB2901-4RD 3SB2901-4RE 100 100 100 100 100 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 102 102 102 102 102 5 6 7 8 9 B B B B B 3SB2901-4RF 3SB2901-4RG 3SB2901-4RH 3SB2901-4RJ 3SB2901-4RK 100 100 100 100 100 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 102 102 102 102 102 Graphic ON/OFF symbols O (Off) 5008 IEC B 3SB2901-4MB 100 10 units 102 I (On) 5007 IEC B 3SB2901-4MC 100 10 units 102 II (On) -- B 3SB2901-4MD 100 10 units 102 * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/13 10 With inscription © Siemens AG 2010 3SB2 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 16 mm Accessories and Spare Parts Insert labels and insert caps Inscription/Symbol Symbol No. DT Insert labels For pushbuttons and illuminated pushbuttons, flat Order No. PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG Price per PU Graphic equipment symbols Electric motor 0011 ISO B 3SB2901-4PA 100 10 units 102 Horn 5014 IEC B 3SB2901-4PB 100 10 units 102 Pump 0134 ISO B 3SB2901-4PD 100 10 units 102 Coolant pump 0355 ISO B 3SB2901-4PE 100 10 units 102 Motion in direction of arrow 5022 IEC B 3SB2901-4NA 100 10 units 102 Motion in direction of arrow -- B 3SB2901-4NB 100 10 units 102 Clockwise rotation 0004 ISO B 3SB2901-4NC 100 10 units 102 Anticlockwise rotation -- B 3SB2901-4ND 100 10 units 102 Fast motion 0266 ISO B 3SB2901-4NE 100 10 units 102 Increase (plus) 5005 IEC B 3SB2901-4NG 100 10 units 102 Decrease (minus) 5006 IEC B 3SB2901-4MC 100 10 units 102 Clamp -- B 3SB2901-4QB 100 10 units 102 Release -- B 3SB2901-4QC 100 10 units 102 Brake off 0021 ISO B 3SB2901-4QE 100 10 units 102 Lock 0022 ISO B 3SB2901-4QF 100 10 units 102 Unlock 0023 ISO B 3SB2901-4QG 100 10 units 102 On/Off, momentary contact 5011 IEC B 3SB2901-4QJ 100 10 units 102 Manual operation 0096 ISO B 3SB2901-4QK 100 10 units 102 Automatic sequence 0017 ISO B 3SB2901-4QL 100 10 units 102 Graphic motion symbols 10 Graphic control symbols Customized inscriptions Any inscription 3SB2901-4AZ 1 line of text with up to 6 characters of 3 mm in height. Please add the appropriate order code to the Order No. and specify the line of text required. C K0Y 1 1 unit 102 B K1Y or K2Y 1 1 unit 102 B K5Y 1 1 unit 102 Other graphic symbols B 3SB2901-4AZ 1 1 unit 102 1 1 unit 102 Please add the order code "K3Y" to the Order No. and specify the serial number and the applied standard (ISO 7000 or IEC 60417). Any inscription or symbol Please add the order code "K9Y" to the Order No. and specify the inscription or the symbol required. 10/14 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 K3Y B 3SB2901-4AZ K9Y * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate © Siemens AG 2010 3SB2 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 16 mm Accessories and Spare Parts Insert labels and insert caps Inscription/Symbol Symbol No. DT Insert caps For pushbuttons and illuminated pushbuttons, raised Order No. PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG Price per PU For self-inscription Blank B 3SB2901-5AA 100 10 units 102 Aus Auf Zu B B B 3SB2901-5AC 3SB2901-5AD 3SB2901-5AL 100 10 units 100 10 units 100 10 units 102 102 102 0 1 2 3 4 C B B B B 3SB2901-5RA 3SB2901-5RB 3SB2901-5RC 3SB2901-5RD 3SB2901-5RE 100 100 100 100 100 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 102 102 102 102 102 5 6 7 8 9 B B B B B 3SB2901-5RF 3SB2901-5RG 3SB2901-5RH 3SB2901-5RJ 3SB2901-5RK 100 100 100 100 100 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 102 102 102 102 102 With inscription Graphic ON/OFF symbols O (Off) 5008 IEC B 3SB2901-5MB 100 10 units 102 I (On) 5007 IEC B 3SB2901-5MC 100 10 units 102 Motion in direction of arrow 5022 IEC B 3SB2901-5NA 100 10 units 102 Motion in direction of arrow -- B 3SB2901-5NB 100 10 units 102 Increase (plus) 5005 IEC B 3SB2901-5NG 100 10 units 102 Decrease (minus) 5006 IEC B 3SB2901-5MC 100 10 units 102 Clamp -- B 3SB2901-5QB 100 10 units 102 Release -- B 3SB2901-5QC 100 10 units 102 Graphic motion symbols 10 Graphic control symbols Customized inscriptions Any inscription 3SB2901-5AZ 1 line of text with up to 6 characters of 3 mm in height. Please add the appropriate order code to the Order No. and specify the line of text required. C K0Y 1 1 unit 102 B K1Y or K2Y 1 1 unit 102 B K5Y 1 1 unit 102 Other graphic symbols B 3SB2901-5AZ 1 1 unit 102 1 1 unit 102 Please add the order code "K3Y" to the Order No. and specify the serial number and the applied standard (ISO 7000 or IEC 60417). Any inscription or symbol Please add the order code "K9Y" to the Order No. and specify the inscription or the symbol required. * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate K3Y B 3SB2901-5AZ K9Y Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/15 © Siemens AG 2010 3SB2 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 16 mm Accessories and Spare Parts Insert labels and insert caps Inscription/Symbol Symbol No. DT Insert caps For indicator lights Order No. PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG Price per PU For self-inscription Blank B 3SB2901-7AA 100 10 units 102 Betrieb B 3SB2901-7AP 100 1 unit 102 Störung B 3SB2901-7AQ 100 10 units 102 With inscription Graphic symbols Pump 0134 ISO B 3SB2901-7PD 100 10 units 102 Manual operation 0096 ISO B 3SB2901-7QK 100 10 units 102 Customized inscriptions Any inscription 3SB2901-7AZ 1 line of text with up to 6 characters of 3 mm in height. Please add the appropriate order code to the Order No. and specify the line of text required. C K0Y 1 1 unit 102 B K1Y or K2Y 1 1 unit 102 B K5Y 1 1 unit 102 Other graphic symbols B 3SB2901-7AZ 1 1 unit 102 1 1 unit 102 Please add the order code "K3Y" to the Order No. and specify the serial number and the applied standard (ISO 7000 or IEC 60417). Any inscription or symbol K3Y B Please add the order code "K9Y" to the Order No. and specify the inscription or the symbol required. 3SB2901-7AZ K9Y ■ Options 10 Customized inscriptions Labels and caps can be inscribed with text and symbols not listed in the ordering data. Append the following codes to the Order No.: • Text line in upper/lower case, always upper case for beginning of line (e.g. "Lift"): K0Y • Text line in upper case (e.g. "LIFT"): K1Y • Text line in lower case (e.g. "lift"): K2Y • Text line in upper/lower case, all words begin with upper case letters (e.g. "Lift Out"): K5Y • Symbol with number according to ISO 7000 or IEC 60417: K3Y • Any inscription or symbols according to order form supplement: K9Y When ordering, specify the required inscription in plain text in addition to the order number and order code. In the case of special inscriptions with words in languages other than German, give the exact spelling and specify the language. 10/16 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 One line with up to 6 characters with 3 mm letter height is possible for the inscription (see ordering example 1). Symbols can also be ordered with numbers according to ISO 7000 or IEC 60417 (see ordering example 2 and 3). For special symbols (order code K9Y), a CAD drawing in DXF format can be submitted. Ordering example 1 3SB29 01–4AZ K1Y Z = pump Ordering example 2 3SB29 01–4AZ K3Y Z = 5008 IEC Ordering example 3 3SB29 01–4AZ K3Y Z = 1118 ISO * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate © Siemens AG 2010 3SB2 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 16 mm Accessories and Spare Parts Name plates ■ Overview The name plates consist of a black plastic label holder and an inscription label (silver with black print) for sticking in place. Inscriptions The inscriptions (also special inscriptions) are lower case with upper case initial letters. Graphic symbols, including those not listed in the catalog, are according to ISO 7000 or IEC 60417. Note mounting dimensions! ■ Selection and ordering data Inscription/Symbol Symbol No. DT Order No. Price per PU PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG Inscription labels, self-adhesive, 9.5 mm × 18.5 mm Blank } 3SB2901-2AA 100 10 units 102 Ein Aus Auf Zu B B B B 3SB2901-2AB 3SB2901-2AC 3SB2901-2AD 3SB2901-2AL 100 100 100 100 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 102 102 102 102 Vor Zurück Schnell Langsam B B B B 3SB2901-2AF 3SB2901-2AG 3SB2901-2AM 3SB2901-2AN 100 100 100 100 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 102 102 102 102 Betrieb Störung Einrichten B B B 3SB2901-2AP 3SB2901-2AQ 3SB2901-2AR 100 10 units 100 10 units 100 10 units 102 102 102 On Off Start Reset Fault B B B B B 3SB2901-2EB 3SB2901-2EC 3SB2901-2EL 3SB2901-2EM 3SB2901-2EW 100 100 100 100 100 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 102 102 102 102 102 Hand Auto Manual 0 Auto Man 0 Auto B B B 3SB2901-2BA 3SB2901-2BE 3SB2901-2ET 100 10 units 100 10 units 100 10 units 102 102 102 5008 IEC B 3SB2901-2MB 100 10 units 102 I (On) 5007 IEC B 3SB2901-2MC 100 10 units 102 O I (horizontal) -- B 3SB2901-2MF 100 10 units 102 Motion in direction of arrow 5002 IEC B 3SB2901-2NA 100 10 units 102 3SB29 01-2XZ Customized inscriptions or symbols (see Options) C K0Y 1 1 unit 102 B K1Y, K2Y or K3Y 1 1 unit 102 B K5Y 1 1 unit 102 B K9Y 1 1 unit 102 B 3SB29 02-0AB 100 10 units 102 Label holders Label holders for inscription labels The label holders must not be used with the 3SB2...-1AC01 EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbutton. ■ Options Customized inscriptions The labels can be inscribed with text and symbols not listed in the ordering data. Append the following codes to the Order No.: • Text line(s) in upper/lower case, upper case always for beginning of line (e.g. "Lift out"): K0Y • Text line(s) in upper case (e.g. "LIFT OUT"): K1Y • Text line(s) in lower case (e.g. "lift out"): K2Y • Text line(s) in upper/lower case, all words begin with upper case letters (e.g. "Lift Out"): K5Y • Symbol with number according to ISO 7000 or IEC 60417: K3Y • Any inscription or symbols according to order form supplement: K9Y When ordering, specify the required inscription in plain text in addition to the order number and order code. * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate In the case of special inscriptions with words in languages other than German, give the exact spelling and specify the language. Two lines of 11 characters are permitted with 4 mm letter height (1 line) or 3 mm (2-line). Symbols can also be ordered with numbers according to ISO 7000 or IEC 60417 (see ordering example). For special symbols (order code K9Y), a CAD drawing in DXF format can be submitted. Ordering example 3SB29 01–2XZ K3Y Z = 1118 ISO Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/17 10 Graphic symbols O (Off) © Siemens AG 2010 3SB2 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 16 mm Accessories and Spare Parts Mounting parts and components ■ Selection and ordering data Version Lamp voltage Color DT Order No. Buttons, flat For pushbuttons Black Red Yellow Green Blue White Clear B B B B B B B Buttons, flat For illuminated pushbuttons Red Yellow Green Blue White Clear Buttons, raised For pushbuttons Price per PU PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG 3SB2910-0AB 3SB2910-0AC 3SB2910-0AD 3SB2910-0AE 3SB2910-0AF 3SB2910-0AG 3SB2910-0AH 100 100 100 100 100 100 100 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 102 102 102 102 102 102 102 B B B B B B 3SB2910-0CC 3SB2910-0CD 3SB2910-0CE 3SB2910-0CF 3SB2910-0AG 3SB2910-0AH 100 100 100 100 100 100 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 102 102 102 102 102 102 Black Red Yellow Clear B B B B 3SB2910-0BB 3SB2910-0BC 3SB2910-0BD 3SB2910-0BH 1 1 1 1 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 102 102 102 102 Buttons, raised For illuminated pushbuttons Red Yellow Clear B B B 3SB2910-0DC 3SB2910-0DD 3SB2910-0BH 1 10 units 1 10 units 1 10 units 102 102 102 Screw lenses With concentric rings Red Yellow Green Blue White Clear B B B B B B 3SB2910-1AC 3SB2910-1AD 3SB2910-1AE 3SB2910-1AF 3SB2910-1AG 3SB2910-1AH 100 100 100 100 100 100 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 102 102 102 102 102 102 Screw lenses Smooth, for inscription with insert cap Red Yellow Green Blue Clear B B B B B 3SB2910-1BC 3SB2910-1BD 3SB2910-1BE 3SB2910-1BF 3SB2910-1BH 100 100 100 100 100 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 102 102 102 102 102 B 3SB2908-2AJ 1 1 unit 102 C B } A B B 3SB2908-1AA 3SB2908-1AB 3SB2908-1AC 3SB2908-1AD 3SB2908-1AE 3SB2908-1AF 100 100 100 100 1 1 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 102 102 102 102 102 102 V Buttons and lenses1) 3SB29 10-0AF 3SB29 10-0CF 3SB29 10-0BD 3SB29 10-0DD 3SB29 10-1AD 3SB29 10-1BE 10 Keys for actuators Keys For CES key-operated switch, lock No. SB2 3SB29 08-2AJ Lamps, Wedge bases2) Incandescent lamps Wedge base W2 × 4.6 d, 1.0 W AC/DC 6 12 24 30 48 60 Clear LED lamps, super-bright Wedge base W2 × 4.6 d 24 AC/DC Red Yellow Green White Blue B B B B B 3SB3901-1SB 3SB3901-1RB 3SB3901-1TB 3SB3901-1UB 3SB2908-1BD 1 1 1 1 1 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 102 102 102 102 102 28 AC/DC Red Yellow Green White Blue B B B B D 3SB3901-1SE 3SB3901-1RE 3SB3901-1TE 3SB3901-1UE 3SB3901-1VE 1 1 1 1 1 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 102 102 102 102 102 } 3SB2908-2AB 1 1 unit 102 3SB29 08-1AE 3SB39 01-1SB 3SB29 08-1BD Lamp extractors For lamps with bases W2 × 4.6 d 3SB29 08-1AB 1) Included in the scope of supply of actuators or indicator lights. 2) Included in the scope of supply of some complete units. 10/18 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate © Siemens AG 2010 3SB2 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 16 mm Accessories and Spare Parts Mounting parts and components Version DT Order No. Price per PU PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG Accessories for command points Single frames for square design1) } 3SB2902-0AA 100 10 units 102 Name plates, yellow, Ø 50 mm As backing plate for EMERGENCY STOP, self-adhesive • Blank • With German inscription "NOT-HALT" • With German inscription "NOT-AUS" } } } 3SB2908-2AF 3SB2908-2AG 3SB2908-2AK 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 Blanking plugs Black plastic (degree of protection IP65) B 3SB2908-3AA 1 1 unit 102 Protective caps, clear Silicone, for pushbuttons with flat and raised button B 3SB2908-3AB 1 1 unit 102 Plug-in sleeves For flat connectors 2.8 × 0.8 mm, cross-section 0.5 ... 1.5 mm2 A 3SB2908-8AA 100 250 units 102 Insulation sleeves For flat connectors, connection from the front D 3SB2908-8AB 100 250 units 102 Complete connectors2) For connecting contact blocks and lampholders (up to 10 connections). Guaranteed finger-safe acc. to IEC 61140 and VBG 4. B 3SB2908-8AD 1 1 unit 102 Plug-in sleeves For flat connectors 2.8 × 0.8 mm, with locating spring for latching in complete connector B 3SB2908-8AE 100 10 units 102 Dismantling tools For holders and lampholders with holder } 3SB2908-2AA 1 1 unit 102 Mounting tools For buttons and screw lenses } 3SB2908-2AC 1 1 unit 102 3SB29 02-0AA T T-HAL NO 3SB29 08-2AG 3SB29 08-3AA 3SB29 08-1 Flat connectors 3SB29 08-8AA 3SB29 08-8AD 3SB29 08-8AE Tools 3SB29 08-2AA 3SB29 08-2AC Crimping tools for non-insulated connections, type KRBC 0560 Art. No. 6179 0950 For plug-in sleeves (both versions) E-mail: info@lappkabel.de Lapp Kabel, Stuttgart www.lappkabel.de 6179 0950 1) Not suitable for EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbuttons. 2) Required 3SB29 08-8AE plug-in sleeves for flat connectors 2.8 × 0.8 mm are not included in the scope of supply. * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/19 10 3SB29 08-8AB © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm General data ■ Overview Front plate mounting D C B E D A F NSD0_00029b C B A A B C D E F Actuator Front plate Holder Contact block Lampholder Support element A B C D E F G Actuator Front plate Holder Holder for printed circuit-board Lampholder Contact block PCB For actuators see page 10/25 to 10/62. For contact blocks and lampholders see page 10/63 to 10/65. For holders see page 10/67. Used on printed circuit boards G F E 10 D C NSD0_00030b B A D A For contact blocks for use on printed circuit boards see page 10/67. 10/20 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 A D © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm General data Design Standards The 3SB3 series is a modular range of commanding and signaling devices for front panel mounting and rear conductor connection. As an alternative, individual elements can also be supplied for use on printed circuit boards. Complete units are offered for the most commonly used applications. IEC 60947-1, EN 60947-1, IEC 60947-5-1, EN 60947-5-1, IEC 60947-5-5, EN 60947-5-5 for EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbuttons. Connection methods The devices are available with screw terminals (box terminals), spring-type terminals or solder pins. Screw terminals Spring-type terminals Solder pin connections The terminals are indicated in the corresponding tables by the symbols shown on orange backgrounds. ■ Application The 3SB3 series is available: • Made of molded plastic in flat, round and square design • Made of metal in round design. The devices are of modern industrial design and can be mounted rapidly by a single person. The operating surfaces of the pushbuttons and illuminated pushbuttons are concave. The lenses of the indicator lights are convex. The metal version with a high degree of protection according to IP67 and NEMA 4 is available for the world market. One command point comprises: • An actuator or lens assembly in front of the control panel • A holder for mounting behind the control panel • Up to 3 contact blocks and/or 1 lampholder behind the control panel • A comprehensive range of accessories for inscription Two contact blocks can be snapped onto the actuator in the standard version. When three contact blocks or illuminated actuators are required, an additional holder must be plugged onto the actuator from the rear. • 3SB39 01-0AB holder for 3 contact blocks or for 2 contact blocks and 1 lampholder • 3SB39 01-0AC holder with pressure plates for actuating a central contact block when using a selector switch, key-operated switch and twin pushbutton with 3 contact blocks. For illuminated pushbuttons, illuminated switches and illuminated selector switches the holder is included in the scope of supply as standard. The contact blocks are fitted with a slow-action contact (1 NO contact or 1 NC contact) with double operating contacts. These ensure a high switching reliability even with small voltages and currents, such as 5 V/1 mA. They are suitable for use in solidstate systems as well as conventional controls. The devices are climate-proof (KTW 24) and suitable for standard industrial applications and operation in marine applications. For operation in oily atmospheres (organic oils/lubricants) we recommend actuators which are marked as "solventresistant". AS-Interface solutions The 3SB3 commanding and signaling devices can be connected to the AS-Interface communication system quickly and safely with the help of various solutions. The following solutions are available: • ASIsafe EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbuttons (see page 10/68) • AS-Interface enclosures with 1 to 6 command points (see page 10/96). • AS-Interface front panel modules for 4 command points (see Catalog IK PI) "Intrinsic safety" type of protection EEx i according to ATEX directive 94/9/EC The pushbuttons and indicator lights in round design can also be used in hazardous areas. The 3SB34 ..-0. contact blocks and the 3SB34 ..-1A lampholders (with 3SB39 01-1.A LED lamp) with screw terminals or spring-type terminals can be used. See Chapter 13 "Appendix" --> "Standards and Approvals" --> "Ex Protection Certificates for SIRIUS Controls". Safety EMERGENCY-STOP pushbuttons according to ISO 13850 For controls according to IEC 60204-1 or EN 60204-1 (VDE 0113 Part 1), the mushroom pushbuttons of the 3SB3 series are suitable for use as safety EMERGENCY-STOP pushbuttons. Safety circuits IEC 60947-5-1 and EN 60947-5-1 require positive opening, i.e. for the purposes of personal safety, the assured opening of NC contacts is expressly stipulated for the electrical equipment of machines in all safety circuits and marked according to IEC 60947-5-1 with the symbol . Category 4 according to EN 954-1 can be attained with the EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbuttons if the corresponding failsafe evaluation units are selected and correctly installed, e.g. the 3TK28 safety relays or matching units from the ASIsafe, SIMATIC or SINUMERIK product ranges. Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/21 10 Actuators and indicators and complete units © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm General data ■ Technical specifications Type 3SB34 00-0, 3SB14 00-0J 3SB34 00-1, 3SB34 03-0, 3SB34 03-1, 3SB34 11-0 3SB34 20-0 3SB34 20-1 3SB34 23-0 3SB34 23-1 3SB34 11-1 Contact blocks and lampholders Standards IEC 60947-5-1, IEC 60947-5-5, EN 60947-5-1, EN 60947-5-5 Connection type Screw terminals Spring-type terminals Rated insulation voltage Ui For pollution degree acc. to IEC 60947-1 V 400 Class 3 250 Class 3 400 Class 3 Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp Solder pins 250 Class 3 60 Class 3 kV 4 4 4 4 4 1.5 Conventional thermal current Ith A 10 -- 10 -- 10 -- • Alternating current 50/60 Hz, AC-12 - At Ue = 24 ... 230 V - At Ue = 400 V A A 10 10 10 ---- 10 10 10 ---- 10 10 -- --- • Alternating current 50/60 Hz, AC-15 - At Ue = 24 ... 230 V - At Ue = 400 V A A 6 3 6 4 --- 6 3 --- 4 -- --- • Direct current DC-12 - At Ue = 24 V - At Ue = 48 V - At Ue = 110 V - At Ue = 230 V A A A A 10 5 2.5 1 10 -2 0.5 ----- 10 5 2.5 1 ----- 10 5 2.5 1 ----- • Direct current DC-13 - At Ue = 24 V - At Ue = 48 V - At Ue = 110 V - At Ue = 230 V A A A A 3 1.5 0.7 0.3 5 -0.5 0.2 ----- 3 1.5 0.7 0.3 ----- 3 1.5 0.7 0.3 ----- Contact stability • Test voltage • Test current V mA 5 1 --- 5 1 --- 5 1 --- Lampholders -- BA 9s -- BA 9s -- Wedge bases Lamps -- Incandescent lamps, glow lamps and LED lamps -- Incandescent lamps, glow lamps and LED lamps -- Incandescent lamps and LED lamps 10 Rated operational current Ie at rated operational voltage Ue Short-circuit protection, weld-free, acc. to IEC 60947-5-1 • DIAZED fuse links, utilization category gG acc. to IEC 60269-3-1 • DIAZED fuse links, quick acc. to DIN VDE 0635 • Miniature circuit breaker with C characteristic acc. to IEC 60898 Dz10 A Dz 16 A A Mechanical endurance 10 × 106 operating cycles Electrical endurance • For utilization category AC-15 with 3RT20 15 to 3RT20 26 contactors • With utilization category DC-12, DC-13 Switching frequency 10 10 × 106 operating cycles With direct current it depends on the operational voltage, the breaking current, the circuit inductance and the switching frequency 1/h 1000 operating cycles Degree of protection acc. to IEC 60529 • Connections • Contact chambers IP20 IP40 Touch protection acc. to EN 61140 and BGV A3 Finger-safe Finger-safe -- -- IP40 -- IP40 Conductor cross-sections1) • Finely stranded, without end sleeves • Finely stranded, with end sleeves to DIN 46228 • Solid • Solid with end sleeves to DIN 46228 • AWG cables, solid or stranded mm2 mm2 mm2 mm2 -2 × (0.5 ... 1.5) 2 × (1 ... 1.5) 2 × (0.5 ... 0.75) 2 × AWG 18 ... 14 2 × (0.25 ... 1.5) 2 × (0.25 ... 0.75) 2 × (0.25 ... 1.5) -2 × AWG 24 ... 16 ------ Tightening torque, terminal screw Nm 0.8 -- -- Solder pins mm2 -- -- 0.8 × 0.8 1) For standard screwdriver size 2 or Pozidriv 2. 10/22 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 -- © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm General data Type 3SB3400-0, 3SB3420-0 3SB3400-1, 3SB3420-1 3SB3403-0, 3SB3423-0 3SB3403-1, 3SB3423-1 3SB3411-0 3SB3411-1 -- 300 -- 300 -- -- 10 -- 10 -- Data according to UL and CSA Rated operational voltage V AC 300 Conventional thermal current (uninterrupted current) A 10 Switching capacity A 300, R 300, A 600 same polarity Rated voltage (lamps) • Lamp with BA 9s base V AC -- 125 -- 125 -- -- • Lamp with wedge base V AC -- 60 -- 60 -- 60 • Lampholders with integrated LED V -- 24 AC/DC, 110 AC, 230 AC -- 24 AC/DC, 110 AC, 230 AC -- -- Rated power (lamps) W -- 2.5 -- 2.5 -- 1 Type 3SB30, 3SB32, (3SB31) 3SB31, 3SB33 3SB35, 3SB36 Actuators and indicators Enclosure material Plastic Design Round Terminal designation acc. to EN 50013 Identification number on the holder, function digit on the contact block Device identification Snap-on label Metal Square Round Tightening torques • Screw on holder Nm max. 1 Mechanical endurance • Pushbuttons 10 × 106 operating cycles • Illuminated pushbuttons 3 × 106 operating cycles • Actuators, rotary or maintained contact 3 × 105 operating cycles • Key-operated switch with key monitoring 1 × 105 operating cycles Switching frequency 1/h Climatic withstand capability acc. to EN ISO 6270-2 1000 operating cycles Climate-proof KTW24; suitable for marine applications • During operation, non-illuminated and with LED °C –25 ... +70 • During operation, devices with incandescent lamp °C –25 ... +60 • During storage, transport °C –40 ... +80 Degree of protection acc. to IEC 60529 • Actuators and indicators, standard IP66 IP65 IP67 and NEMA Type 4 IP67 IP67 -- • Key-operated switch with key monitoring IP54 -- -- • Twin pushbuttons (3SB31) IP65 -- -- Protective measures Protective measures are met automatically when the actuators Grounding is necessary for and lens assemblies are mounted on metal front plates and operation with protective enclosures. extra-low voltage (PELV). - With protective caps When mounted in insulated enclosures, the "total insulation" protective measures are met. Shock resistance acc. to IEC 60068-2-27 for half-sine shock type, 11 ms shock duration • Devices without incandescent lamp ≤ 50 g • Devices with incandescent lamp ≤ 30 g Vibration resistance acc. to IEC 60068-2-6 • Acceleration at frequency 20 ... 200 Hz 5g Type 3SB380.-0, 3SB380.-1 -- 3SB380.-2, 3SB380.-3 Enclosures Enclosure material Plastic Metal Actuators and indicators Plastic, round Metal, round Degree of protection acc. to IEC 60529 IP65 IP67 and NEMA Type 4 Resistance to extreme climates acc. to DIN 50017 KTW 24 KTW 24 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/23 10 Ambient temperature © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm General data Mounting depth Configuration The 3SB3 devices can be easily and quickly mounted: • Actuators or indicator lights are positioned in the opening of the front panel from the front • Position the holder from the rear • Tighten the screw on the holder • Snap on the contact block or the lampholder directly onto the actuator from the back NSD0_00217 49 29 30 20 Pushbuttons with two contact blocks For a switchboard thickness of 3 to 6 mm, the holder is reversed and mounted in the direction of the arrow at ↑ 3–6 mm ↑ and the fixing screw is located on the upper right. In this case, the fixing screw must be rotated anticlockwise to its limit before mounting the holder. max. 24 The holder for the round versions is set to a switchboard thickness of 1 to 4 mm when delivered and is placed in the direction of the arrow ↑ 1–4 mm ↑ on the actuator/indicator from the back. The fixing screw is located underneath, on the right. max. 24 Mounting and fixing 49 29 30 NSD0_00218 The control panel depth of 1 to 4 mm can be compensated with the holder for the square version. When label holders, protective caps or similar accessories are used, the greatest permissible control panel thickness must be reduced by the wall thickness of the accessory part. 10 30 Mounting dimensions on front plates Illuminated pushbuttons with lampholder and two contact blocks +0,2 29 a b Contact blocks (1 contact) and lampholder • For front plate mounting, with screw terminals • For front plate mounting with spring-type terminals • For use on PCB, with solder pin connections 301) 301) 301) 45 301) 301) Contact blocks with 2 contacts • For front plate mounting 301) 50 NSD0_00220a a Minimum clearance 10 30 Illuminated pushbuttons with lampholder and two contact blocks with two contacts Used on printed circuit boards 452) 60 1) For mushroom pushbutton, EMERGENCY-STOP and push-pull button: Note mushroom diameter d = 40 mm or 60 mm. 2) 60 mm with contact blocks having two contacts. NO 1 2 3 NSD0_00227b 4 min. 7.62 max. 10.16 min. 7,62, max. 10,16 1 2 3 4 Solder pin 1.3 +0.1 PCB holder +0.1 Centring hole 4.2 Lampholder Illuminated pushbutton with solder pins 10/24 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 NC 5.08 301) 301) 15.24 20.32 When using holders for inscription labels • 12.5 mm × 27 mm • 27.0 mm × 27 mm 63 NSD0_00151 a 30 NSD0_00226a a 45 10 a b b NSD0_00150 Ø22,3 -0 max. 24 26,0 -0 +0,4 2.54 © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Actuators and Indicators, Plastic, Round, 22 mm Complete units ■ Selection and ordering data The following applies to all complete units: PU (UNIT) = 1 PS* = 1 UNIT PG = 102 Rated voltage of lamp Color of handle Contacts for front plate mounting DT Screw terminals Order No. V DT Spring-type terminals Price per PU Order No. Price per PU Pushbuttons Pushbuttons with flat button -- Pushbutton with flat button Black Black Red Yellow Green Blue White 1 NO 1 NC 1 NC 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO } B } B } B } 3SB3202-0AA11 3SB3203-0AA11 3SB3203-0AA21 3SB3202-0AA31 3SB3202-0AA41 3SB3202-0AA51 3SB3202-0AA61 B B B B B B B 3SB3202-0AA11-0CC0 3SB3203-0AA11-0CC0 3SB3203-0AA21-0CC0 3SB3202-0AA31-0CC0 3SB3202-0AA41-0CC0 3SB3202-0AA51-0CC0 3SB3202-0AA61-0CC0 Black Red Yellow Green Blue White 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC B B B B B B 3SB3201-0AA11 3SB3201-0AA21 3SB3201-0AA31 3SB3201-0AA41 3SB3201-0AA51 3SB3201-0AA61 B B B B B B 3SB3201-0AA11-0CC0 3SB3201-0AA21-0CC0 3SB3201-0AA31-0CC0 3SB3201-0AA41-0CC0 3SB3201-0AA51-0CC0 3SB3201-0AA61-0CC0 Illuminated pushbutton with flat button 1) 24 AC/DC Red1) Yellow1) Green1) Blue1) White Clear1) 1 NC 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO } B } B B } 3SB3246-0AA21 3SB3245-0AA31 3SB3245-0AA41 3SB3245-0AA51 3SB3245-0AA61 3SB3245-0AA71 B B B B B B 3SB3246-0AA21-0CC0 3SB3245-0AA31-0CC0 3SB3245-0AA41-0CC0 3SB3245-0AA51-0CC0 3SB3245-0AA61-0CC0 3SB3245-0AA71-0CC0 24 AC/DC Red1) Yellow1) Green1) Blue1) White Clear1) 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC B B B B B B 3SB3247-0AA21 3SB3247-0AA31 3SB3247-0AA41 3SB3247-0AA51 3SB3247-0AA61 3SB3247-0AA71 B B B B B B 3SB3247-0AA21-0CC0 3SB3247-0AA31-0CC0 3SB3247-0AA41-0CC0 3SB3247-0AA51-0CC0 3SB3247-0AA61-0CC0 3SB3247-0AA71-0CC0 110 AC Red1) Yellow1) Green1) Blue1) White Clear1) 1 NC 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO B B B B B B 3SB3250-0AA21 3SB3257-0AA31 3SB3257-0AA41 3SB3257-0AA51 3SB3257-0AA61 3SB3257-0AA71 ------- 110 AC Red1) Yellow1) Green1) Blue1) White Clear1) 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC B B B C B B 3SB3251-0AA21 3SB3251-0AA31 3SB3251-0AA41 3SB3251-0AA51 3SB3251-0AA61 3SB3251-0AA71 ------- 230 AC Red1) Yellow1) Green1) Blue1) White Clear1) 1 NC 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO } B } B B } 3SB3254-0AA21 3SB3253-0AA31 3SB3253-0AA41 3SB3253-0AA51 3SB3253-0AA61 3SB3253-0AA71 B B B B B B 3SB3254-0AA21-0CC0 3SB3253-0AA31-0CC0 3SB3253-0AA41-0CC0 3SB3253-0AA51-0CC0 3SB3253-0AA61-0CC0 3SB3253-0AA71-0CC0 230 AC Red1) Yellow1) Green1) Blue1) White Clear1) 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC B B B B B B 3SB3255-0AA21 3SB3255-0AA31 3SB3255-0AA41 3SB3255-0AA51 3SB3255-0AA61 3SB3255-0AA71 B B B B B B 3SB3255-0AA21-0CC0 3SB3255-0AA31-0CC0 3SB3255-0AA41-0CC0 3SB3255-0AA51-0CC0 3SB3255-0AA61-0CC0 3SB3255-0AA71-0CC0 10 Illuminated pushbuttons with flat button with integrated LED (incl. holder for 3 elements) Inscription is possible by inserting a label. * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/25 © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Actuators and Indicators, Plastic, Round, 22 mm Complete units PU (UNIT) = 1 PS* = 1 UNIT PG = 102 Color of handle Contacts for front plate mounting DT Screw terminals Order No. DT Spring-type terminals Price per PU Order No. Price per PU Pushbuttons Illuminated pushbuttons with flat button With BA 9s lampholder, without lamp (incl. holder for 3 elements) Illuminated pushbutton with flat button Red1) Yellow1) Green1) Blue1) White Clear1) 1 NC 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO B B B B B B 3SB3207-0AA21 3SB3206-0AA31 3SB3206-0AA41 3SB3206-0AA51 3SB3206-0AA61 3SB3206-0AA71 B B B B B B 3SB3207-0AA21-0CC0 3SB3206-0AA31-0CC0 3SB3206-0AA41-0CC0 3SB3206-0AA51-0CC0 3SB3206-0AA61-0CC0 3SB3206-0AA71-0CC0 Red1) Yellow1) Green1) Blue1) White Clear1) 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC B B B B B B 3SB3205-0AA21 3SB3205-0AA31 3SB3205-0AA41 3SB3205-0AA51 3SB3205-0AA61 3SB3205-0AA71 B B B B B B 3SB3205-0AA21-0CC0 3SB3205-0AA31-0CC0 3SB3205-0AA41-0CC0 3SB3205-0AA51-0CC0 3SB3205-0AA61-0CC0 3SB3205-0AA71-0CC0 1 NC } 3SB3203-1CA21 B 3SB3203-1CA21-0CC0 1 NO + 1 NC B 3SB3201-1CA21 B 3SB3201-1CA21-0CC0 Mushroom pushbuttons Mushroom push-pull buttons, Ø 40 mm, latching With pull-to-unlatch mechanism Red Mushroom push-pull button Inscription is possible by inserting a label. 10 1) 10/26 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Actuators and Indicators, Plastic, Round, 22 mm Complete units PU (UNIT) = 1 PS* = 1 UNIT PG = 102 Version Color of handle/ Lock No. Contacts for front plate mounting DT Screw terminals Order No. DT Spring-type terminals Price per PU Order No. Price per PU Selector switches Selector switches, 2 switch positions Switching sequence O-I, 50° operating angle Latching Black 1 NO } 3SB3202-2KA11 B 3SB3202-2KA11-0CC0 1 NO + 1 NC B 3SB3201-2KA11 B 3SB3201-2KA11-0CC0 1 NO B 3SB3202-2HA11 -- 1 NO + 1 NC B 3SB3201-2HA11 -- 1 NO, 1 NO } 3SB3210-2DA11 B 3SB3210-2DA11-0CC0 1 NO + 1 NC, 1 NO + 1 NC B 3SB3208-2DA11 B 3SB3208-2DA11-0CC0 1 NO, 1 NO B 3SB3210-2EA11 B 3SB3210-2EA11-0CC0 1 NO + 1 NC, 1 NO + 1 NC B 3SB3208-2EA11 C 3SB3208-2EA11-0CC0 Selector switches, 2 switch positions Switching sequence O-I, 90° operating angle Latching Black Selector switch Selector switches, 3 switch positions Switching sequence I-O-II, 2 x 50° operating angle Latching Momentary contact type Black Black Key-operated switches RONIS key-operated switches, 2 switch positions With 2 keys, removal position O + I, switching sequence O-I, 50° operating angle Latching SB 30 1 NO } 3SB3202-4AD11 B 3SB3202-4AD11-0CC0 1 NO + 1 NC B 3SB3201-4AD11 B 3SB3201-4AD11-0CC0 1 NO + 1 NC, 1 NO + 1 NC D 3SB3100-8AC61 10 RONIS key-operated switch Twin pushbuttons Twin pushbuttons With flat, square buttons1) With I/O inscription White/White -- Twin pushbutton with flat buttons 1) Mounting the twin pushbuttons in 3SB38 enclosure is not possible. For accessories, see page 10/41. * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/27 © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Actuators and Indicators, Plastic, Round, 22 mm Complete units PU (UNIT) = 1 PS* = 1 UNIT PG = 102 Color of handle DT Screw terminals Contacts for front plate mounting Order No. DT Spring-type terminals Price per PU Order No. Price per PU EMERGENCY-STOP devices according to ISO 13850, with yellow name plate, Ø 80 mm, with inscription EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbuttons, Ø 40 mm, with positive latching function With rotate-to-unlatch mechanism • German inscription "NOT-HALT" Red 1 NC 1) } 3SB3203-1HA20 B 3SB3203-1HA20-0CC0 Red 1 NO + 1 NC 1) B 3SB3201-1HA20 B 3SB3201-1HA20-0CC0 • English inscription "EMERGENCY STOP" With rotate-to-unlatch mechanism Red 1 NC 1) B 3SB3203-1HR20 -- Red 1 NO + 1 NC 1) B 3SB3201-1HR20 -- • French inscription "ARRET D’URGENCE" Red 1 NC 1) B 3SB3203-1HP20 -- Red 1 NO + 1 NC 1) B 3SB3201-1HP20 -- With rotate-to-unlatch mechanism and mechanical switch position indication • German inscription "NOT-HALT" Red 1 NC 1) } 3SB3203-1HA26 B 3SB3203-1HA26-0CC0 Red 1 NO + 1 NC 1) B 3SB3201-1HA26 B 3SB3201-1HA26-0CC0 • English inscription "EMERGENCY STOP" With rotate-to-unlatch mechanism and switch position indication Red 1 NC 1) B 3SB3203-1HR26 -- Red 1 NO + 1 NC 1) B 3SB3201-1HR26 -- With pull-to-unlatch mechanism 10 • German inscription "NOT-HALT" Red 1 NC 1) B 3SB3203-1TA20 -- Red 1 NO + 1 NC 1) B 3SB3201-1TA20 -- • English inscription "EMERGENCY STOP" With pull-to-unlatch mechanism 1) Red 1 NC 1) B 3SB3203-1TR20 -- Red 1 NO + 1 NC 1) B 3SB3201-1TR20 -- Positive opening according to IEC 60947-5-1, Appendix K. Can be used with 3TK28 safety relays. Certificate: 10/28 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Actuators and Indicators, Plastic, Round, 22 mm Complete units PU (UNIT) = 1 PS* = 1 UNIT PG = 102 Rated voltage of lamp Color of lens DT Screw terminals Order No. V DT Spring-type terminals Price per PU Order No. Price per PU Indicator lights Indicator lights with smooth lens1) With integrated LED 24 AC/DC Red Yellow Green Blue White Clear } B } B B } 3SB3244-6AA20 3SB3244-6AA30 3SB3244-6AA40 3SB3244-6AA50 3SB3244-6AA60 3SB3244-6AA70 110 AC Red Yellow Green Blue White Clear B B B B B B 3SB3248-6AA20 3SB3248-6AA30 3SB3248-6AA40 3SB3248-6AA50 3SB3248-6AA60 3SB3248-6AA70 230 AC Red Yellow Green Blue White Clear } B } B B } 3SB3252-6AA20 3SB3252-6AA30 3SB3252-6AA40 3SB3252-6AA50 3SB3252-6AA60 3SB3252-6AA70 B B B B B B 3SB3252-6AA20-0CC0 3SB3252-6AA30-0CC0 3SB3252-6AA40-0CC0 3SB3252-6AA50-0CC0 3SB3252-6AA60-0CC0 3SB3252-6AA70-0CC0 Red Yellow Green Blue White Clear B B B B B B 3SB3204-6AA20 3SB3204-6AA30 3SB3204-6AA40 3SB3204-6AA50 3SB3204-6AA60 3SB3204-6AA70 B B B B B B 3SB3204-6AA20-0CC0 3SB3204-6AA30-0CC0 3SB3204-6AA40-0CC0 3SB3204-6AA50-0CC0 3SB3204-6AA60-0CC0 3SB3204-6AA70-0CC0 24 AC/DC Red Yellow Green Blue White Clear } B } B B } 3SB3244-6BA20 3SB3244-6BA30 3SB3244-6BA40 3SB3244-6BA50 3SB3244-6BA60 3SB3244-6BA70 B B B B B B 3SB3244-6BA20-0CC0 3SB3244-6BA30-0CC0 3SB3244-6BA40-0CC0 3SB3244-6BA50-0CC0 3SB3244-6BA60-0CC0 3SB3244-6BA70-0CC0 110 AC Red Yellow Green Blue White Clear B B B B B B 3SB3248-6BA20 3SB3248-6BA30 3SB3248-6BA40 3SB3248-6BA50 3SB3248-6BA60 3SB3248-6BA70 230 AC Red Yellow Green Blue White Clear } B } B B } 3SB3252-6BA20 3SB3252-6BA30 3SB3252-6BA40 3SB3252-6BA50 3SB3252-6BA60 3SB3252-6BA70 B B B B B B 3SB3252-6BA20-0CC0 3SB3252-6BA30-0CC0 3SB3252-6BA40-0CC0 3SB3252-6BA50-0CC0 3SB3252-6BA60-0CC0 3SB3252-6BA70-0CC0 B B B B B B B 3SB3204-6BA00 3SB3204-6BA20 3SB3204-6BA30 3SB3204-6BA40 3SB3204-6BA50 3SB3204-6BA60 3SB3204-6BA70 B B B B B B -3SB3204-6BA20-0CC0 3SB3204-6BA30-0CC0 3SB3204-6BA40-0CC0 3SB3204-6BA50-0CC0 3SB3204-6BA60-0CC0 3SB3204-6BA70-0CC0 B B B B B B B 3SB3240-6BA00 3SB3240-6BA20 3SB3240-6BA30 3SB3240-6BA40 3SB3240-6BA50 3SB3240-6BA60 3SB3240-6BA70 Indicator light with smooth lens B B B B B B 3SB3244-6AA20-0CC0 3SB3244-6AA30-0CC0 3SB3244-6AA40-0CC0 3SB3244-6AA50-0CC0 3SB3244-6AA60-0CC0 3SB3244-6AA70-0CC0 ------- With BA 9s lampholder, without lamp -- Indicator lights with lens with concentric rings1) With integrated LED 10 Indicator light with lens with concentric rings ------- With BA 9s lampholder, without lamp -- Amber Red Yellow Green Blue White Clear With BA 9s lampholder, with LED 130 AC 1) Amber Red Yellow Green Blue White Clear -------- Inscription by inserting a label is not possible. * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/29 © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Actuators and Indicators, Plastic, Round, 22 mm Complete units Version Rated voltage Color of of lamp lens DT Screw terminals Order No. V PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG Price per PU Signaling devices Acoustic signaling devices, IP651) Continuous tone 2.4 kHz, 24 AC/DC operational current min. 4 mA, 115 AC/DC sound pressure 230 AC/DC min. 80 dB/10 cm X1 (L+) 3SB3233-7BA10 3SB3234-7BA10 3SB3235-7BA10 Black A B A Color of handle DT Without connection X2 (L-) NSD00003 Acoustic signaling device 1) Mounting in 3SB38 enclosure only with 3SB3400-1A lampholder; not possible with 3SB3420-1A lampholder for floor mounting. Version Degree of protection Order No. Price per PU Special devices Drives for potentiometers2)3) With shaft Ø 6 mm, 30 ... 32 mm long IP65 B 3SB1000-7CH07 1 1 unit 102 B 3SB3000-0EA11 1 1 unit 102 Potentiometer drive Pushbuttons with extended stroke2) For actuating relays IP65 Black 10 12 mm stroke Pushbutton with 12 mm stroke 2) Mounting in 3SB38 enclosure is not possible. 3) The potentiometer is not included in the scope of supply. 10/30 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Actuators and Indicators, Plastic, Round, 22 mm Coordinate switches, complete ■ Overview Operation The 3SB14 00-0J contact block is used, which due to its depth cannot be built into 3SB38 enclosures. Switches are available as follows: • With 2 or 4 switch positions • Latching or momentary contact type • With or without mechanical interlocking In the case of switches with mechanical interlock in O position, the switch is unlatched with the unlatching button at the front of the actuating lever. Inscriptions A name plate consisting of a black, plastic label holder and two or four adhesive, silver-colored inscription labels of 27 mm x 27 mm in size is available for labeling purposes. These labels can be supplied with and without customized inscription. Note mounting dimensions! Coordinate switch with contact blocks Joystick switches control auxiliary circuits permitting movements in various directions of machines and equipment. The switches are designed for front panel mounting. They are climate-proof. ■ Selection and ordering data Version DT Screw terminals Operating travel Contact closed Contact open Order No. PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG Price per PU Coordinate switches 2 switch positions, 1 NO per direction Horizontal, momentary contact type NSD01077 A 0 B NSD01079 A B 43-44 33-34 • With plastic front ring, black B 3SB1201-7DV01 1 1 unit 102 • With metal front ring B 3SB1201-7DV20 1 1 unit 102 • With plastic front ring, black B 3SB1201-7DW01 1 1 unit 102 • With metal front ring B 3SB1201-7DW20 1 1 unit 102 • With plastic front ring, black B 3SB1201-7FV01 1 1 unit 102 • With metal front ring B 3SB1201-7FV20 1 1 unit 102 • With plastic front ring, black B 3SB1201-7FW01 1 1 unit 102 • With metal front ring B 3SB1201-7FW20 1 1 unit 102 With mechanical locking in the O position Coordinate switch, 2 switch positions Vertical, momentary contact type NSD01078 NSD01080 D 0 C 13-14 23-24 D C 0 Without mechanical locking in the O position With mechanical locking in the O position * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/31 10 0 Without mechanical locking in the O position © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Actuators and Indicators, Plastic, Round, 22 mm Coordinate switches, complete Version DT Screw terminals Operating travel Contact closed Contact open Order No. PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG Price per PU Coordinate switches 2 switch positions, 1 NO per direction Horizontal, latching NSD01077 A 0 B NSD01079 A B 43-44 33-34 0 Without mechanical locking in the O position • With plastic front ring, black B 3SB1201-7EV01 1 1 unit 102 • With metal front ring B 3SB1201-7EV20 1 1 unit 102 • With plastic front ring, black B 3SB1201-7EW01 1 1 unit 102 • With metal front ring B 3SB1201-7EW20 1 1 unit 102 • With plastic front ring, black B 3SB1201-7GV01 1 1 unit 102 • With metal front ring B 3SB1201-7GV20 1 1 unit 102 • With plastic front ring, black B 3SB1201-7GW01 1 1 unit 102 • With metal front ring B 3SB1201-7GW20 1 1 unit 102 • With plastic front ring, black B 3SB1208-7JV01 1 1 unit 102 • With metal front ring B 3SB1208-7JV20 1 1 unit 102 • With plastic front ring, black B 3SB1208-7JW01 1 1 unit 102 • With metal front ring B 3SB1208-7JW20 1 1 unit 102 • With plastic front ring, black B 3SB1208-7KV01 1 1 unit 102 • With metal front ring B 3SB1208-7KV20 1 1 unit 102 • With plastic front ring, black B 3SB1208-7KW01 1 1 unit 102 • With metal front ring B 3SB1208-7KW20 1 1 unit 102 With mechanical locking in the O position Coordinate switch, 2 switch positions Vertical, latching NSD01078 NSD01080 D 0 C 13-14 23-24 D C 0 Without mechanical locking in the O position With mechanical locking in the O position 4 switch positions, 1 NO per direction Momentary contact type D A 0 B C 43-44 33-34 A B 13-14 23-24 D C NSD00076 10 0 Coordinate switch, 4 switch positions NSD00077 Without mechanical locking in the O position With mechanical locking in the O position Latching D A 0 B C 43-44 33-34 A B NSD00076 13-14 23-24 D C 0 NSD00077 Without mechanical locking in the O position With mechanical locking in the O position 10/32 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Actuators and Indicators, Plastic, Round, 22 mm Coordinate switches, complete ■ Accessories Version Contact blocks DT Screw terminals Symbols/ operating travel Contact closed Contact open Order No. PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG 1 1 unit 102 PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG Price per PU Spare contact blocks (in scope of supply of switch) .3 .3 .4 .4 C NSD00104 Contact blocks with 2 contacts 1 NO, 1 NO A B .3/.4 .3/.4 NSD00109a 0 3SB14 00-0J 3SB1400-0J Version DT Order No. Price per PU Name plates Label holders for joystick switches 2 switch positions, horizontal, 89 mm × 30 mm B 3SB1906-0AU 1 1 unit 102 2 switch positions, vertical, 30 mm × 89 mm B 3SB1906-0AV 1 1 unit 102 4 switch positions B 3SB1906-0AW 1 1 unit 102 B 3SB1906-2AA 100 10 units 102 Inscription labels 27 mm × 27 mm, silver-colored, for sticking in place Without inscription 3SB1906-2XZ With inscription (engraved) D K0Y, K1Y, K2Y, or K5Y 1 1 unit 102 • Graphic symbol with number according to ISO 7000 or IEC 60417 D K3Y 1 1 unit 102 • Any inscription or symbol D K9Y 1 1 unit 102 10 3SB19 06-0AV • Text lines (up to 5 lines each with 11 characters) 3SB19 06-0AW For black plastic labels, see page 10/74. ■ Options Customized inscriptions These labeling plates can be inscribed with text or symbols. 5 lines with 11 characters each in a letter height of 4 mm are possible. Ordering notes Append the following codes to the Order No.: • Text line(s) in upper/lower case, upper case always for beginning of line (e.g. "Lift off"): K0Y • Text line(s) in upper case (e.g. "LIFT OFF"): K1Y • Text line(s) in lower case (e.g. "lift off"): K2Y • Text line(s) in upper/lower case, all words begin with upper case letters (e.g. "Lift Off"): K5Y • Symbol with number according to ISO 7000 or IEC 60417: K3Y • Any inscription or symbol according to order form supplement: K9Y When ordering, specify the required inscription in plain text in addition to the order number and order code. In the case of special inscriptions with words in languages other than German, give the exact spelling and specify the language. In the case of multi-line inscriptions, the text must be assigned to the respective line, e.g. "Z1 = Lift, Z2 =Lower". Symbols can also be ordered with numbers according to ISO 7000 or IEC 60417. For special symbols (order code K9Y), a CAD drawing in DXF format can be submitted. Ordering example A label inscribed with symbol No. 1117 according to ISO 7000 is required: 3SB19 06-2XZ K3Y Z = 1117 ISO For other ordering examples see page 10/77. * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/33 © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Actuators and Indicators, Plastic, Round, 22 mm Actuators and indicators ■ Selection and ordering data Version Inscriptions Color of handle DT Order No. Black Red Yellow Green Blue White Gray Clear2) } } B } B } B B Green Red White Black Blue Pushbuttons with raised button Price per PU PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG 3SB3000-0AA11 3SB3000-0AA21 3SB3000-0AA31 3SB3000-0AA41 3SB3000-0AA51 3SB3000-0AA61 3SB3000-0AB51 3SB3000-0AA71 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 102 102 B B B B B 3SB3000-0AA81 3SB3000-0AB01 3SB3000-0AB11 3SB3000-0AB21 3SB3000-0AC81 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 Black Red Yellow Green Blue White B B B B B B 3SB3000-0BA11 3SB3000-0BA21 3SB3000-0BA31 3SB3000-0BA41 3SB3000-0BA51 3SB3000-0BA61 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 Pushbuttons with raised button, latching by pressing in and turning to the right, unlatches by turning to the left Black Red } B 3SB3000-0CA11 3SB3000-0CA21 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 Pushbuttons with raised front ring (height 13 mm) Black Red Yellow Green Blue White B B B B B B 3SB3000-0AA12 3SB3000-0AA22 3SB3000-0AA32 3SB3000-0AA42 3SB3000-0AA52 3SB3000-0AA62 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 Pushbuttons with raised front ring, castellated (height 13 mm) Black Red Yellow Green B B B B 3SB3000-0AA13 3SB3000-0AA23 3SB3000-0AA33 3SB3000-0AA43 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 Illuminated pushbuttons with flat button (incl. holder for 3 elements) Amber2) Red2) Yellow2) Green2) Blue2) White Clear2) C } } } B B } 3SB3001-0AA01 3SB3001-0AA21 3SB3001-0AA31 3SB3001-0AA41 3SB3001-0AA51 3SB3001-0AA61 3SB3001-0AA71 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 102 Illuminated pushbuttons with raised button (incl. holder for 3 elements) Red Yellow Green Blue Clear B B B B B 3SB3001-0BA21 3SB3001-0BA31 3SB3001-0BA41 3SB3001-0BA51 3SB3001-0BA71 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 Pushbuttons with flat button, latching, unlatches by pressing again Black Red Yellow Green Blue White Gray B B B B B B C 3SB3000-0DA11 3SB3000-0DA21 3SB3000-0DA31 3SB3000-0DA41 3SB3000-0DA51 3SB3000-0DA61 3SB3000-0DB51 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 102 Illuminated pushbuttons with flat button, latching, unlatches by pressing again (incl. holder for 3 elements) Red2) Yellow2) Green2) Blue2) White Clear2) B B B B B B 3SB3001-0DA21 3SB3001-0DA31 3SB3001-0DA41 3SB3001-0DA51 3SB3001-0DA61 3SB3001-0DA71 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 Pushbuttons with holder1) Pushbuttons with flat button I O I O R With flat button With raised button 10 With raised button, latching With raised front ring With raised front ring, castellated Illuminated pushbutton with raised button 1) Also available without holder. Supplement Order No. with "-Z" and quote order code "B01". 2) Inscription is possible by inserting a label. 10/34 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Actuators and Indicators, Plastic, Round, 22 mm Actuators and indicators Version Color of handle DT Order No. Mushroom pushbuttons, Ø 30 mm Black Red Yellow Green B B B B Mushroom pushbuttons, Ø 40 mm Black Red Yellow Green Mushroom pushbuttons, Ø 60 mm Price per PU PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG 3SB3000-1DA11 3SB3000-1DA21 3SB3000-1DA31 3SB3000-1DA41 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 } } B B 3SB3000-1GA11 3SB3000-1GA21 3SB3000-1GA31 3SB3000-1GA41 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 Black Red Yellow Green B B B B 3SB3000-1QA11 3SB3000-1QA21 3SB3000-1QA31 3SB3000-1QA41 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 Illuminated mushroom pushbuttons, Ø 30 mm (incl. holder for 3 elements) Red Yellow Green Blue White Clear B B B B B B 3SB3001-1DA21 3SB3001-1DA31 3SB3001-1DA41 3SB3001-1DA51 3SB3001-1DA61 3SB3001-1DA71 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 Illuminated mushroom pushbuttons, Ø 40 mm (incl. holder for 3 elements) Yellow Green White B B B 3SB3001-1GA31 3SB3001-1GA41 3SB3001-1GA61 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 Push-pull buttons, Ø 30 mm, latching, pull to unlatch Black Red B B 3SB3000-1EA11 3SB3000-1EA21 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 Push-pull buttons, Ø 40 mm, latching, pull to unlatch Black Red } } 3SB3000-1CA11 3SB3000-1CA21 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 Push-pull buttons, Ø 60 mm, latching, pull to unlatch Black Red B B 3SB3000-1RA11 3SB3000-1RA21 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 Push-pull buttons, Ø 30 mm, can be illuminated, latching, pull to unlatch, (incl. holder for 3 elements) Red Yellow Green Blue Clear B B B B B 3SB3001-1EA21 3SB3001-1EA31 3SB3001-1EA41 3SB3001-1EA51 3SB3001-1EA71 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 Push-pull buttons, Ø 40 mm, can be illuminated, latching, pull to unlatch (incl. holder for 3 elements) Red Yellow Green Blue Clear B B B B B 3SB3001-1CA21 3SB3001-1CA31 3SB3001-1CA41 3SB3001-1CA51 3SB3001-1CA71 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 1) Also available without holder. Supplement Order No. with "-Z" and quote order code "B01". * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate 2) Maximum permissible equipment: 3 single-pole or 2 double-pole contact blocks. When using the 3SB39 01-0AB holder, the central command point must not be empty. Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/35 10 Mushroom pushbuttons with holder1)2) © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Actuators and Indicators, Plastic, Round, 22 mm Actuators and indicators Version Version Illumination Color of handle DT Order No. Black Red Green White B B B B Illuminated Red (incl. holder for Yellow 3 elements) Green Blue Clear Nonilluminated Price per PU PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG 3SB3000-2HA11 3SB3000-2HA21 3SB3000-2HA41 3SB3000-2HA61 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 B B B B B 3SB3001-2HA21 3SB3001-2HA31 3SB3001-2HA41 3SB3001-2HA51 3SB3001-2HA71 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 Black Red Green White } B B B 3SB3000-2KA11 3SB3000-2KA21 3SB3000-2KA41 3SB3000-2KA61 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 Illuminated Red (incl. holder for Yellow 3 elements) Green Blue Clear B B B B B 3SB3001-2KA21 3SB3001-2KA31 3SB3001-2KA41 3SB3001-2KA51 3SB3001-2KA71 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 Nonilluminated Black Red Green White } B B B 3SB3000-2LA11 3SB3000-2LA21 3SB3000-2LA41 3SB3000-2LA61 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 Illuminated Red (incl. holder for Yellow 3 elements) Green Blue Clear B B B B B 3SB3001-2LA21 3SB3001-2LA31 3SB3001-2LA41 3SB3001-2LA51 3SB3001-2LA71 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 Black Red Green White } B B B 3SB3000-2DA11 3SB3000-2DA21 3SB3000-2DA41 3SB3000-2DA61 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 Illuminated Red (incl. holder for Yellow 3 elements) Green Blue Clear B B B B B 3SB3001-2DA21 3SB3001-2DA31 3SB3001-2DA41 3SB3001-2DA51 3SB3001-2DA71 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 Nonilluminated Black Red Green White } B B B 3SB3000-2EA11 3SB3000-2EA21 3SB3000-2EA41 3SB3000-2EA61 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 Illuminated Red (incl. holder for Yellow 3 elements) Green Blue Clear B B B B B 3SB3001-2EA21 3SB3001-2EA31 3SB3001-2EA41 3SB3001-2EA51 3SB3001-2EA71 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 Black Red Green White } B B B 3SB3000-2GA11 3SB3000-2GA21 3SB3000-2GA41 3SB3000-2GA61 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 Illuminated Red (incl. holder for Yellow 3 elements) Green Blue Clear B B B B B 3SB3001-2GA21 3SB3001-2GA31 3SB3001-2GA41 3SB3001-2GA51 3SB3001-2GA71 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 Black Red Green White B B B B 3SB3000-2FA11 3SB3000-2FA21 3SB3000-2FA41 3SB3000-2FA61 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 Illuminated Red (incl. holder for Yellow 3 elements) Green Blue Clear B B B C B 3SB3001-2FA21 3SB3001-2FA31 3SB3001-2FA41 3SB3001-2FA51 3SB3001-2FA71 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 Selector switches with holder1) Selector switches with 2 switch positions Switching sequence O-I, 90° operating angle, latching Non-illuminated Switching sequence O-I, 50° operating angle, latching Switching sequence O-I, 50° operating angle, momentary contact type Illuminated Nonilluminated Selector switches with 3 switch positions Switching sequence I-O-II, Non2 x 50° operating angle, illuminated latching 10 Non-illuminated Illuminated Switching sequence I-O-II, 2 x 50° operating angle, momentary contact type NonSwitching sequence I-O-II, illuminated 2 x 50° operating angle, momentary contact type to the left, latching to the right NonSwitching sequence I-O-II, illuminated 2 x 50° operating angle, latching to the left, momentary contact type to the right 1) Also available without holder. Supplement Order No. with "-Z" and quote order code "B01". 10/36 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Actuators and Indicators, Plastic, Round, 22 mm Actuators and indicators Version Lock version Type DT Order No. Lock No./ Key color removal position Price per PU PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG Key-operated switches with holder1) Switching sequence O-I, RONIS 50° operating angle, latching SB 30 O+I O I B B B 3SB3000-4HD11 3SB3000-4HD01 3SB3000-4HD21 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 Switching sequence O-I, RONIS 50° operating angle, RONIS key-operated switch latching CES SB 30 O+I O I } } B 3SB3000-4AD11 3SB3000-4AD01 3SB3000-4AD21 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 SSG 10 O+I O I } } B 3SB3000-4LD11 3SB3000-4LD01 3SB3000-4LD21 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 LSG 1 O+I O B B 3SB3000-4LF01 3SB3000-4LF11 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 CES with key SSG 10 monitoring2) O C 3SB3000-4LD05 1 1 unit 102 BKS S1 O+I O I B B B 3SB3000-5AD11 3SB3000-5AD01 3SB3000-5AD21 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 E1 for VW3) O+I O B B 3SB3000-5AE01 3SB3000-5AE11 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 E2 for VW3) O+I O B B 3SB3000-5AE21 3SB3000-5AE31 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 E7 for VW3) O+I O B B 3SB3000-5AE41 3SB3000-5AE51 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 E9 for VW3) O+I O B B 3SB3000-5AE61 3SB3000-5AE71 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 73038 O+I Light blue O B B 3SB3000-3AG11 3SB3000-3AG01 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 73037 Red O+I O B B 3SB3000-3AH11 3SB3000-3AH01 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 73034 Black O+I O B B 3SB3000-3AJ11 3SB3000-3AJ01 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 73033 Yellow O+I O B B 3SB3000-3AK11 3SB3000-3AK01 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 CES key-operated switch O.M.R.4) BKS key-operated switch Switching sequence O-I, RONIS 50° operating angle, CES momentary contact type O.M.R. key-operated switch SB 30 O } 3SB3000-4BD01 1 1 unit 102 SSG 10 O } 3SB3000-4MD01 1 1 unit 102 LSG 1 O B 3SB3000-4MF11 1 1 unit 102 BKS S1 O B 3SB3000-5BD01 1 1 unit 102 O.M.R.4) 73038 O Light blue B 3SB3000-3BG01 1 1 unit 102 73037 Red O B 3SB3000-3BH01 1 1 unit 102 73034 Black O B 3SB3000-3BJ01 1 1 unit 102 73033 Yellow O B 3SB3000-3BK01 1 1 unit 102 For BKS and CES special locks, see page 10/69. 1) Also available without holder. Supplement Order No. with "-Z" and quote order code "B01". 2) For locks with key monitoring the supplied 3SB39 01-0AB holder must be used. The key scan is performed by a 3SB34 single-pole NC contact block which must be snap-mounted in the center position. Scanning of the switch positions must be performed by additional contact blocks which are snapmounted on the actuator. Special locks can be ordered only with order code "Y01". 3) Keys are not included in scope of supply. 4) According to FIAT standards; also available for other users. * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/37 10 Key-operated switches with 2 keys, 2 switch positions © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Actuators and Indicators, Plastic, Round, 22 mm Actuators and indicators Version Lock version Type DT Order No. Lock No./ Key color removal position Price per PU PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG Key-operated switches with holder1) Key-operated switches with 2 keys, 3 switch positions SB 30 I+O+II O I+II I II O+I B B B B B B 3SB3000-4DD11 3SB3000-4DD01 3SB3000-4DD41 3SB3000-4DD21 3SB3000-4DD31 3SB3000-4DD51 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 SSG 10 I+O+II O O+I I+II I II B B B B B B 3SB3000-4PD11 3SB3000-4PD01 3SB3000-4PD51 3SB3000-4PD41 3SB3000-4PD21 3SB3000-4PD31 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 CES with key SSG 10 monitoring2) O C 3SB3000-4PD05 1 1 unit 102 BKS S1 I+O+II II B C 3SB3000-5DD11 3SB3000-5DD31 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 O.M.R.3) 73038 I+O+II Light blue O B B 3SB3000-3DG11 3SB3000-3DG01 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 73037 Red O O+I B B 3SB3000-3DH01 3SB3000-3DH51 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 73034 Black I+O+II O B B 3SB3000-3DJ11 3SB3000-3DJ01 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 73033 Yellow I+O+II B 3SB3000-3DK11 1 1 unit 102 Switching sequence I-O-II, RONIS 2 x 50° operating angle, latching CES RONIS key-operated switch CES key-operated switch SB 30 O B 3SB3000-4ED01 1 1 unit 102 SSG 10 O B 3SB3000-4QD01 1 1 unit 102 S1 O B 3SB3000-5ED01 1 1 unit 102 73034 Black O B 3SB3000-3EJ01 1 1 unit 102 SB 30 O + II O II B B B 3SB3000-4GD61 3SB3000-4GD01 3SB3000-4GD31 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 SSG 10 O + II O B B 3SB3000-4SD61 3SB3000-4SD01 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 S1 O B 3SB3000-5GD01 1 1 unit 102 SB 30 O+I O I B B B 3SB3000-4FD51 3SB3000-4FD01 3SB3000-4FD21 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 SSG 10 O+I O I B B B 3SB3000-4RD51 3SB3000-4RD01 3SB3000-4RD21 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 BKS S1 O+I O I B B B 3SB3000-5FD51 3SB3000-5FD01 3SB3000-5FD21 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 O.M.R.3) 73038 O Light blue B 3SB3000-3FG01 1 1 unit 102 73034 Black B 3SB3000-3FJ21 1 1 unit 102 Switching sequence I-O-II, RONIS 2 x 50° operating angle, CES momentary contact type BKS O.M.R.3) BKS key-operated switch Switching sequence I-O-II, RONIS 2 x 50° operating angle, momentary contact type to the left, CES latching to the right 10 BKS Switching sequence I-O-II, RONIS 2 x 50° operating angle, latching to the left, O.M.R. key-operated switch momentary contact type to CES the right I For BKS and CES special locks, see page 10/69. 1) Also available without holder. Supplement Order No. with "-Z" and quote order code "B01". 2) For locks with key monitoring the supplied 3SB39 01-0AB holder must be used. The key scan is performed by a 3SB34 single-pole NC contact block which must be snap-mounted in the center position. Scanning of the switch positions must be performed by additional contact blocks which are snapmounted on the actuator. Special locks can be ordered only with order code "Y01". 3) According to FIAT standards; also available for other users. 10/38 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Actuators and Indicators, Plastic, Round, 22 mm Actuators and indicators Version Color of handle Approval DT Order No. Price PU (UNIT, per PU SET, M) PS* PG EMERGENCY-STOP devices according to ISO 13850 and IEC 60947-5-5, with holder1)2). Can also be used with 3TK28 safety relays. B 3SB3000-1FA20 1 1 unit 102 • Without switch position indicator } 3SB3000-1HA20 1 1 unit 102 • With mechanical switch position indication A 3SB3000-1HA26 1 1 unit 102 EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbuttons, Ø 32 mm With positive latching according to ISO 13850, with rotate-to-unlatch mechanism Red EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbuttons, Ø 40 mm With positive latching according to ISO 13850, with rotate-to-unlatch mechanism Red Mushroom diameter 32 mm Mushroom diameter 40 mm, with rotate-to-unlatch mechanism with switch position indication EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbuttons, Ø 40 mm With positive latching according to ISO 13850, with pull-to-unlatch mechanism Red B 3SB3000-1TA20 1 1 unit 102 EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbuttons, Ø 60 mm With positive latching according to ISO 13850, with rotate-to-unlatch mechanism Red B 3SB3000-1AA20 1 1 unit 102 EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbuttons, Ø 40 mm, with RONIS key-operated switch, lock No. SB 30, with positive latching according to ISO 13850, unlocking only possible using key Red B 3SB3000-1BA20 1 1 unit 102 EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbuttons, Ø 40 mm, with CES key-operated switch, lock No. SSG 10, with positive latching according to ISO 13850, unlocking only possible using key Red B 3SB3000-1KA20 1 1 unit 102 EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbuttons, Ø 40 mm, with BKS key-operated switch, lock No. S1, with positive latching according to ISO 13850, unlocking only possible using key Red B 3SB3000-1LA20 1 1 unit 102 EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbuttons, Ø 40 mm, with O.M.R. key-operated switch, Mushroom diameter 40 mm, lock No. 73037, with CES key-operated switch with positive latching according to ISO 13850, unlocking only possible using key Red B 3SB3000-1MA20 1 1 unit 102 10 Mushroom diameter 40 mm, pull-to-unlatch mechanism Mushroom diameter 60 mm Mushroom diameter 40 mm, with RONIS key-operated switch For BKS and CES special locks, see page 10/69. 1) Also available without holder. Supplement Order No. with "-Z" and quote order code "B01". 2) * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate The yellow backing plates must be ordered separately, see Accessories. Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/39 © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Actuators and Indicators, Plastic, Round, 22 mm Actuators and indicators Version Color of lens DT Order No. Price per PU PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG Signaling elements with holder1) Indicator light with concentric rings Indicator lights With smooth lens2) Amber Red Yellow Green Blue White Clear B } B } B B } 3SB3001-6AA00 3SB3001-6AA20 3SB3001-6AA30 3SB3001-6AA40 3SB3001-6AA50 3SB3001-6AA60 3SB3001-6AA70 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 102 Indicator lights With lens with concentric rings2) Amber Red Yellow Green Blue White Clear B B B B B B B 3SB3001-6BA00 3SB3001-6BA20 3SB3001-6BA30 3SB3001-6BA40 3SB3001-6BA50 3SB3001-6BA60 3SB3001-6BA70 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 102 Acoustic signaling devices, IP403) For acoustic signal transformer 24 V DC4) (without BA 9s base) Black B 3SB3000-7AA10 1 1 unit 102 Acoustic signaling device 1) Also available without holder. Supplement Order No. with "-Z" and quote order code "B01". 2) Inscription by inserting a label is not possible. 3) For acoustic signaling devices, IP65, see Complete Units. Version Inscriptions 4) To order 3SB1902-2BN acoustic signal transformers separately, see Accessories. The 3SB34 00-1A lampholder is also required; only version with screw terminals can be used. With front mounting, use in the enclosure is also possible. Color of handle DT Order No. Price per PU PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG Twin pushbuttons with indicator light with holder1)2) I/O3) I/O3) Green/Red White/Black B B 3SB3101-8BC21 3SB3101-8BC31 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 ↑/↓3) Green/Red D 3SB3101-8BC81 1 1 unit 102 Twin pushbuttons with indicator light With flat and raised, square buttons, incl. holder for 3 elements I/O3) I/O3) Green/Red White/Black B B 3SB3101-8DC21 3SB3101-8DC31 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 10 Twin pushbuttons with indicator light With flat, square buttons, incl. holder for 3 elements Twin pushbutton with indicator light, with flat buttons Twin pushbutton with indicator light, with flat and raised buttons 1) Mounting the twin pushbuttons in 3SB38 enclosure is not possible. 2) Also available without holder. Supplement Order No. with "-Z" and quote order code "B01". 3) Black inscription for green, red and white buttons; white inscription on black button. 10/40 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Actuators and Indicators, Plastic, Round, 22 mm Actuators and indicators Version Inscriptions Color of handle DT Order No. Twin pushbuttons With flat, square buttons I/O3) I/O3) Green/Red White/Black B B 3SB3100-8AC21 3SB3100-8AC31 ↑/↓3) White/White B 3SB3100-8AC61-0AD0 Twin pushbuttons With flat and raised, square buttons I/O3) I/O3) Green/Red White/Black B B 3SB3100-8CC21 3SB3100-8CC31 Price per PU PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG 100 10 units 102 Twin pushbuttons with holder1)2) Twin pushbutton with flat buttons 1) Mounting the twin pushbuttons in 3SB38 enclosure is not possible. 2) Also available without holder. Supplement Order No. with "-Z" and quote order code "B01". 3) Black inscription for green, red and white buttons; white inscription on black button. Version Use DT Order No. Label holders 70 mm x 30 mm For inscription label 12.5 mm x 27 mm1) Twin pushbuttons B 3SB3922-0AY Protective caps, clear Silicone, for degree of protection IP67 Twin pushbuttons with flat buttons B 3SB3921-0AQ Price per PU Accessories for twin pushbuttons 1 1 unit 102 Protective cap 1) Mounting in 3SB38 enclosure is not possible. For blank labels see pages 10/73 and 10/74. * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/41 10 Label holder © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Actuators and Indicators, Plastic, Square, 26 mm × 26 mm Complete units ■ Selection and ordering data Version Rated voltage of lamp Color of Contacts for DT Screw terminals handle front plate mounting Order No. V PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG Price per PU Pushbuttons Pushbuttons with flat button -- Pushbutton Illuminated pushbuttons with flat button With integrated LED (incl. holder for 3 elements) 24 AC/DC Illuminated pushbutton Illuminated pushbuttons with flat button With integrated LED (incl. holder for 3 elements) 10 Illuminated pushbuttons with flat button With BA 9s lampholder without lamp (incl. holder for 3 elements) 1) 230 AC Black Black Red Yellow Green Blue White 1 NO 1 NC 1 NC 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO B B B B B B B 3SB3302-0AA11 3SB3303-0AA11 3SB3303-0AA21 3SB3302-0AA31 3SB3302-0AA41 3SB3302-0AA51 3SB3302-0AA61 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 102 Black Red Yellow Green Blue White 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC B B B B C B 3SB3301-0AA11 3SB3301-0AA21 3SB3301-0AA31 3SB3301-0AA41 3SB3301-0AA51 3SB3301-0AA61 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 Red1) Yellow1) Green1) Blue1) White Clear1) 1 NC 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO B B B B B B 3SB3346-0AA21 3SB3345-0AA31 3SB3345-0AA41 3SB3345-0AA51 3SB3345-0AA61 3SB3345-0AA71 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 Red1) Yellow1) Green1) Blue1) White Clear1) 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC B B B B B B 3SB3347-0AA21 3SB3347-0AA31 3SB3347-0AA41 3SB3347-0AA51 3SB3347-0AA61 3SB3347-0AA71 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 Red1) Yellow1) Green1) Blue1) White Clear1) 1 NC 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO B C B C B B 3SB3354-0AA21 3SB3353-0AA31 3SB3353-0AA41 3SB3353-0AA51 3SB3353-0AA61 3SB3353-0AA71 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 Red1) Yellow1) Green1) Blue1) White Clear1) 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC B C B C C B 3SB3355-0AA21 3SB3355-0AA31 3SB3355-0AA41 3SB3355-0AA51 3SB3355-0AA61 3SB3355-0AA71 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 Red1) Yellow1) Green1) Blue1) White Clear1) 1 NC 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO B B B B B B 3SB3307-0AA21 3SB3306-0AA31 3SB3306-0AA41 3SB3306-0AA51 3SB3306-0AA61 3SB3306-0AA71 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 Red1) Yellow1) Green1) Blue1) White Clear1) 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC B B B B B B 3SB3305-0AA21 3SB3305-0AA31 3SB3305-0AA41 3SB3305-0AA51 3SB3305-0AA61 3SB3305-0AA71 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 Inscription is possible by inserting a label. 10/42 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Actuators and Indicators, Plastic, Square, 26 mm × 26 mm Complete units Version Color of handle DT Screw terminals Contacts for front plate mounting Order No. PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG Price per PU EMERGENCY-STOP devices acc. to ISO 13850, with yellow name plate, Ø 80 mm, with inscription1). Can also be used with 3TK28 safety relays. EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbuttons, Ø 40 mm, with positive latching function With rotate-to-unlatch mechanism Red 1 NC 2) B 3SB3303-1HA20 1 1 unit 102 1 NO + 1 NC 2) B 3SB3301-1HA20 1 1 unit 102 DT Screw terminals PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbutton Rotate-to-unlatch mechanism 1) German inscription "NOT-HALT". 2) Positive opening according to IEC 60947-5-1, Appendix K. Can be used with 3TK28 safety relays. Certificate: Version Rated voltage of lamp Color of lens Order No. V Price per PU Indicator lights With integrated LED 24 AC/DC Red Yellow Green Blue White Clear B B B B B B 3SB3344-6AA20 3SB3344-6AA30 3SB3344-6AA40 3SB3344-6AA50 3SB3344-6AA60 3SB3344-6AA70 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 Indicator lights With integrated LED 230 AC Red Yellow Green Blue White Clear B B B B B B 3SB3352-6AA20 3SB3352-6AA30 3SB3352-6AA40 3SB3352-6AA50 3SB3352-6AA60 3SB3352-6AA70 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 Indicator lights with BA 9s lampholder (without lamp) – Red Yellow Green Blue White Clear B B B B B B 3SB3304-6AA20 3SB3304-6AA30 3SB3304-6AA40 3SB3304-6AA50 3SB3304-6AA60 3SB3304-6AA70 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 Indicator light * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/43 10 Signaling devices © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Actuators and Indicators, Plastic, Square, 26 mm × 26 mm Actuators and indicators ■ Selection and ordering data Version Color of handle DT Order No. Price per PU PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG Pushbuttons and switches with holder1) Pushbuttons with flat button Black Red Yellow Green Blue White Clear2) B B B B B B B 3SB3110-0AA11 3SB3110-0AA21 3SB3110-0AA31 3SB3110-0AA41 3SB3110-0AA51 3SB3110-0AA61 3SB3110-0AA71 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 102 Pushbuttons with raised front ring (height 13 mm) Black Red Green White B B C B 3SB3110-0AA12 3SB3110-0AA22 3SB3110-0AA42 3SB3110-0AA62 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 Pushbuttons with raised front ring, castellated (height 13 mm) Black Red Yellow Green White C C C C C 3SB3110-0AA13 3SB3110-0AA23 3SB3110-0AA33 3SB3110-0AA43 3SB3110-0AA63 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 Illuminated pushbuttons with flat button (incl. holder for 3 elements) Red2) Yellow2) Green2) Blue2) White Clear2) B B B B B B 3SB3111-0AA21 3SB3111-0AA31 3SB3111-0AA41 3SB3111-0AA51 3SB3111-0AA61 3SB3111-0AA71 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 Pushbuttons, latching, with flat button Unlocking by pressing again Black Red Yellow Green Blue White B B B B C B 3SB3110-0DA11 3SB3110-0DA21 3SB3110-0DA31 3SB3110-0DA41 3SB3110-0DA51 3SB3110-0DA61 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 Illuminated pushbuttons, latching, with flat button (incl. holder for 3 elements), unlatches by pressing again, Red2) Yellow2) Green2) Blue2) White Clear2) B B B B B B 3SB3111-0DA21 3SB3111-0DA31 3SB3111-0DA41 3SB3111-0DA51 3SB3111-0DA61 3SB3111-0DA71 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 Pushbutton Pushbutton with raised front ring Pushbutton with raised front ring, castellated 10 Illuminated pushbutton Pushbutton Illuminated pushbutton 1) Also available without holder. Supplement Order No. with "-Z" and quote order code "B01". 2) Inscription is possible by inserting a label. 10/44 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Actuators and Indicators, Plastic, Square, 26 mm × 26 mm Actuators and indicators Version Version Illumination Color of handle DT Order No. Black Red Green White B B B B Illuminated Red (incl. holder for Yellow 3 elements) Green Blue Clear Nonilluminated Price per PU PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG 3SB3110-2KA11 3SB3110-2KA21 3SB3110-2KA41 3SB3110-2KA61 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 B B B B B 3SB3111-2KA21 3SB3111-2KA31 3SB3111-2KA41 3SB3111-2KA51 3SB3111-2KA71 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 Black Red Green White B C C C 3SB3110-2LA11 3SB3110-2LA21 3SB3110-2LA41 3SB3110-2LA61 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 Illuminated Red (incl. holder for Yellow 3 elements) Green Blue Clear B C C C B 3SB3111-2LA21 3SB3111-2LA31 3SB3111-2LA41 3SB3111-2LA51 3SB3111-2LA71 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 Black Red Green White B B C C 3SB3110-2DA11 3SB3110-2DA21 3SB3110-2DA41 3SB3110-2DA61 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 Illuminated Red (incl. holder for Yellow 3 elements) Green Blue Clear B B B C B 3SB3111-2DA21 3SB3111-2DA31 3SB3111-2DA41 3SB3111-2DA51 3SB3111-2DA71 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 Nonilluminated Black Red Green White B B C C 3SB3110-2EA11 3SB3110-2EA21 3SB3110-2EA41 3SB3110-2EA61 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 Illuminated Red (incl. holder for Yellow 3 elements) Green Blue Clear C C B C B 3SB3111-2EA21 3SB3111-2EA31 3SB3111-2EA41 3SB3111-2EA51 3SB3111-2EA71 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 Selector switches with holder1) Selector switches with 2 switch positions Switching sequence O-I, 50° operating angle, latching Selector switch Switching sequence O-I, 50° operating angle, momentary contact type Selector switch, illuminated Nonilluminated Switching sequence I-O-II, 2 x 50° operating angle, latching Selector switch Switching sequence I-O-II, 2 x 50° operating angle, momentary contact type Selector switch, illuminated NonSwitching sequence I-O-II, illuminated 2 x 50° operating angle, momentary contact type to the left, latching to the right Black Green White B C B 3SB3110-2GA11 3SB3110-2GA41 3SB3110-2GA61 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 Nonilluminated Black Red Green B C B 3SB3110-2FA11 3SB3110-2FA21 3SB3110-2FA41 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 Switching sequence I-O-II, 2 x 50° operating angle, latching to the left, momentary contact type to the right 1) Nonilluminated Also available without holder. Supplement Order No. with "-Z" and quote order code "B01". * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/45 10 Selector switches with 3 switch positions © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Actuators and Indicators, Plastic, Square, 26 mm × 26 mm Actuators and indicators Version Lock version Type DT Order No. Lock No./ Key color removal position Price per PU PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG Key-operated switches with holder1) Key-operated switches with 2 keys, 2 switch positions Switching sequence O-I, 50° operating angle, latching RONIS key-operated switch RONIS SB 30 O+I O B B 3SB3110-4AD11 3SB3110-4AD01 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 CES SSG 10 O+I O I B B B 3SB3110-4LD11 3SB3110-4LD01 3SB3110-4LD21 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 LSG 1 O+I O C B 3SB3110-4LF01 3SB3110-4LF11 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 E2 for VW2) O B 3SB3110-5AE31 1 1 unit 102 E7 for VW2) O+I O B B 3SB3110-5AE41 3SB3110-5AE51 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 E9 for VW2) O B 3SB3110-5AE71 1 1 unit 102 73037 Red O B 3SB3110-3AH01 1 1 unit 102 73034 Black O+I B 3SB3110-3AJ11 1 1 unit 102 BKS O.M.R.3) CES key-operated switch Switching sequence O-I, 50° operating angle, momentary contact type RONIS SB 30 O B 3SB3110-4BD01 1 1 unit 102 CES SSG 10 O B 3SB3110-4MD01 1 1 unit 102 Key-operated switches with 2 keys, 3 switch positions Switching sequence I-O-II, RONIS 2 x 50° operating angle, CES latching I+O+II B 3SB3110-4DD11 1 1 unit 102 I+O+II O B B 3SB3110-4PD11 3SB3110-4PD01 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 SB 30 O B 3SB3110-4ED01 1 1 unit 102 SSG 10 O B 3SB3110-4QD01 1 1 unit 102 Switching sequence I-O-II, CES 2 x 50° operating angle, momentary contact type to the left, latching to the right SSG 10 O B 3SB3110-4SD01 1 1 unit 102 Switching sequence I-O-II, CES 2 x 50° operating angle, latching to the left, momentary contact type to the right SSG 10 O+I C 3SB3110-4RD51 1 1 unit 102 Switching sequence I-O-II, RONIS O.M.R. key-operated switch 2 x 50° operating angle, CES momentary contact type 10 SB 30 SSG 10 For BKS and CES special locks, see page 10/69. 1) Also available without holder. Supplement Order No. with "-Z" and quote order code "B01". 2) Keys are not included in scope of supply. 3) According to FIAT standards; also available for other users. 10/46 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Actuators and Indicators, Plastic, Square, 26 mm × 26 mm Actuators and indicators Version Color of handle Approval DT Order No. Price per PU PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG EMERGENCY-STOP devices according to ISO 13850 and IEC 60947-5-5, with holder1)2). Can also be used with 3TK28 safety relays. EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbuttons, Ø 40 mm, with positive latching acc. to ISO 13850, rotate-to-unlatch mechanism Red B 3SB3110-1HA20 1 1 unit 102 EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbuttons, Ø 40 mm, with RONIS key-operated switch (with 2 keys), lock No. SB 30, with positive latching acc. to ISO 13850, unlocking only possible using key Red B 3SB3110-1BA20 1 1 unit 102 EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbuttons, Ø 40 mm, with CES key-operated switch (with 2 keys), lock No. SSG 10, with positive latching acc. to ISO 13850, unlocking only possible using key Red B 3SB3110-1KA20 1 1 unit 102 EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbuttons, Ø 40 mm, with BKS key-operated switch (with 2 keys), EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbutton with lock No. S1, with positive latching acc. to ISO 13850, CES key-operated switch unlocking only possible using key Red B 3SB3110-1LA20 1 1 unit 102 EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbuttons, Ø 40 mm, with O.M.R. key-operated switch (with 2 keys), lock No. 73037 with positive latching acc. to ISO 13850, unlocking only possible using key Red B 3SB3110-1MA20 1 1 unit 102 Price PU (UNIT, per PU SET, M) PS* PG 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbutton, rotate-tounlatch mechanism EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbutton with O.M.R. key-operated switch For BKS and CES special locks, see page 10/69. 1) Also available without holder. Supplement Order No. with "-Z" and quote order code "B01". 2) The yellow backing plates must be ordered separately, see Accessories. Version Color of lens DT Order No. Red Yellow Green Blue Clear White B B B B B B Signaling elements with holder1) Indicator lights 3SB3111-6AA20 3SB3111-6AA30 3SB3111-6AA40 3SB3111-6AA50 3SB3111-6AA70 3SB3111-6AA60 Indicator light 1) Also available without holder. Supplement Order No. with "-Z" and quote order code "B01". * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/47 10 EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbutton with RONIS key-operated switch © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Actuators and Indicators, Metal, Round, 22 mm Complete units ■ Selection and ordering data The following applies to all complete units: PU (UNIT) = 1 PS* = 1 UNIT PG = 102 Rated voltage of lamp Color of handle Contacts for front plate mounting DT Screw terminals Order No. V DT Spring-type terminals Price per PU Order No. Price per PU Pushbuttons Pushbuttons with flat button -- Pushbutton with flat button Black Black Red Yellow Green Blue White 1 NO 1 NC 1 NC 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO } B } B } B } 3SB3602-0AA11 3SB3603-0AA11 3SB3603-0AA21 3SB3602-0AA31 3SB3602-0AA41 3SB3602-0AA51 3SB3602-0AA61 C C C C C C C 3SB3602-0AA11-0CC0 3SB3603-0AA11-0CC0 3SB3603-0AA21-0CC0 3SB3602-0AA31-0CC0 3SB3602-0AA41-0CC0 3SB3602-0AA51-0CC0 3SB3602-0AA61-0CC0 Black Red Yellow Green Blue White Clear 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC B B B B B B B 3SB3601-0AA11 3SB3601-0AA21 3SB3601-0AA31 3SB3601-0AA41 3SB3601-0AA51 3SB3601-0AA61 3SB3601-0AA71 C C C C C C 3SB3601-0AA11-0CC0 3SB3601-0AA21-0CC0 3SB3601-0AA31-0CC0 3SB3601-0AA41-0CC0 3SB3601-0AA51-0CC0 3SB3601-0AA61-0CC0 -- Illuminated pushbuttons with flat button With integrated LED (incl. holder for 3 elements) 24 AC/DC Illuminated pushbutton with flat button 10 110 AC 230 AC 1) Red1) Yellow1) Green1) Blue1) White Clear1) 1 NC 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO } B } B B } 3SB3646-0AA21 3SB3645-0AA31 3SB3645-0AA41 3SB3645-0AA51 3SB3645-0AA61 3SB3645-0AA71 C C C C C C 3SB3646-0AA21-0CC0 3SB3645-0AA31-0CC0 3SB3645-0AA41-0CC0 3SB3645-0AA51-0CC0 3SB3645-0AA61-0CC0 3SB3645-0AA71-0CC0 Red1) Yellow1) Green1) Blue1) White Clear1) 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC B B B B B B 3SB3647-0AA21 3SB3647-0AA31 3SB3647-0AA41 3SB3647-0AA51 3SB3647-0AA61 3SB3647-0AA71 C C C C C C 3SB3647-0AA21-0CC0 3SB3647-0AA31-0CC0 3SB3647-0AA41-0CC0 3SB3647-0AA51-0CC0 3SB3647-0AA61-0CC0 3SB3647-0AA71-0CC0 Red1) Yellow1) Green1) Blue1) White Clear1) 1 NC 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO B B B B B D 3SB3650-0AA21 3SB3657-0AA31 3SB3657-0AA41 3SB3657-0AA51 3SB3657-0AA61 3SB3657-0AA71 ------- Red1) Yellow1) Green1) Blue1) White Clear1) 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC B B B D B B 3SB3651-0AA21 3SB3651-0AA31 3SB3651-0AA41 3SB3651-0AA51 3SB3651-0AA61 3SB3651-0AA71 ------- Red1) Yellow1) Green1) Blue1) White Clear1) 1 NC 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO } B } D B } 3SB3654-0AA21 3SB3653-0AA31 3SB3653-0AA41 3SB3653-0AA51 3SB3653-0AA61 3SB3653-0AA71 C C C C C C 3SB3654-0AA21-0CC0 3SB3653-0AA31-0CC0 3SB3653-0AA41-0CC0 3SB3653-0AA51-0CC0 3SB3653-0AA61-0CC0 3SB3653-0AA71-0CC0 Red1) Yellow1) Green1) Blue1) White Clear1) 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC B B B D B B 3SB3655-0AA21 3SB3655-0AA31 3SB3655-0AA41 3SB3655-0AA51 3SB3655-0AA61 3SB3655-0AA71 C C C C C C 3SB3655-0AA21-0CC0 3SB3655-0AA31-0CC0 3SB3655-0AA41-0CC0 3SB3655-0AA51-0CC0 3SB3655-0AA61-0CC0 3SB3655-0AA71-0CC0 Inscription is possible by inserting a label. 10/48 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Actuators and Indicators, Metal, Round, 22 mm Complete units PU (UNIT) = 1 PS* = 1 UNIT PG = 102 Rated voltage of lamp Color of handle Contacts for front plate mounting DT Screw terminals Order No. V DT Spring-type terminals Price per PU Order No. Price per PU Pushbuttons Illuminated pushbuttons with flat button With BA 9s lampholder, without lamp (incl. holder for 3 elements) -- Illuminated pushbutton with flat button Red1) Amber1) Yellow1) Green1) Blue1) White Clear1) 1 NC 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO B D B B B B B 3SB3607-0AA21 3SB3606-0AA01 3SB3606-0AA31 3SB3606-0AA41 3SB3606-0AA51 3SB3606-0AA61 3SB3606-0AA71 C C C C C 3SB3607-0AA21-0CC0 -3SB3606-0AA31-0CC0 3SB3606-0AA41-0CC0 3SB3606-0AA51-0CC0 3SB3606-0AA61-0CC0 3SB3606-0AA71-0CC0 Red1) Amber1) Yellow1) Green1) Blue1) White Clear1) 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC B B B B B B B 3SB3605-0AA21 3SB3605-0AA01 3SB3605-0AA31 3SB3605-0AA41 3SB3605-0AA51 3SB3605-0AA61 3SB3605-0AA71 C C C C C 3SB3605-0AA21-0CC0 -3SB3605-0AA31-0CC0 3SB3605-0AA41-0CC0 3SB3605-0AA51-0CC0 3SB3605-0AA61-0CC0 3SB3605-0AA71-0CC0 Illuminated pushbuttons with flat, solvent-resistant button2), With integrated LED (incl. holder for 3 elements) 24 AC/DC Illuminated pushbutton with flat button Red1) Yellow1) Green1) Blue1) White Clear1) 1 NC 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO 1 NO B B B B B B 3SB3646-0AA21-0PA0 3SB3645-0AA31-0PA0 3SB3645-0AA41-0PA0 3SB3645-0AA51-0PA0 3SB3645-0AA61-0PA0 3SB3645-0AA71-0PA0 ------- Red1) Yellow1) Green1) Blue1) White Clear1) 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC B B B B B B 3SB3647-0AA21-0PA0 3SB3647-0AA31-0PA0 3SB3647-0AA41-0PA0 3SB3647-0AA51-0PA0 3SB3647-0AA61-0PA0 3SB3647-0AA71-0PA0 ------- 1 NC B 3SB3603-1CA21 C 3SB3603-1CA21-0CC0 1 NO + 1 NC B 3SB3601-1CA21 C 3SB3601-1CA21-0CC0 Mushroom pushbuttons -- Red 10 Mushroom push-pull buttons, Ø 40 mm, latching With pull-to-unlatch mechanism Mushroom push-pull button 1) Inscription is possible by inserting a label. 2) Not suitable for laser inscription. * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/49 © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Actuators and Indicators, Metal, Round, 22 mm Complete units PU (UNIT) = 1 PS* = 1 UNIT PG = 102 Version Color of handle/ Lock No. Contacts for front plate mounting DT Screw terminals Order No. DT Spring-type terminals Price per PU Order No. Price per PU Selector switches Selector switches, 2 switch positions Switching sequence O-I, 50° operating angle Latching Selector switch Black 1 NO } 3SB3602-2KA11 C 3SB3602-2KA11-0CC0 Standard 1 NO + 1 NC B 3SB3601-2KA11 C 3SB3601-2KA11-0CC0 Heavy duty 1 NO D 3SB3602-2PA11 -- 1 NO + 1 NC D 3SB3601-2PA11 -- Selector switches, 3 switch positions Switching sequence I-O-II, 2 x 50° operating angle Latching Black Heavy duty Momentary contact type Black Heavy duty } 3SB3610-2DA11 C 3SB3610-2DA11-0CC0 1 NO + 1 NC, } 1 NO + 1 NC 3SB3608-2DA11 C 3SB3608-2DA11-0CC0 1 NO, 1 NO 1 NO, 1 NO D 3SB3610-2SA11 -- 1 NO + 1 NC, D 1 NO + 1 NC 3SB3608-2SA11 -- } 3SB3610-2EA11 C 3SB3610-2EA11-0CC0 1 NO + 1 NC, B 1 NO + 1 NC 3SB3608-2EA11 C 3SB3608-2EA11-0CC0 1 NO, 1 NO D 3SB3610-2TA11 -- 1 NO + 1 NC, D 1 NO + 1 NC 3SB3608-2TA11 -- 1 NO, 1 NO Key-operated switches RONIS key-operated switches, 2 switch positions With 2 keys, removal position O + I, switching sequence O-I, 50° operating angle Latching SB 30 1 NO } 3SB3602-4AD11 C 3SB3602-4AD11-0CC0 1 NO + 1 NC B 3SB3601-4AD11 C 3SB3601-4AD11-0CC0 10 RONIS key-operated switch 10/50 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Actuators and Indicators, Metal, Round, 22 mm Complete units PU (UNIT) = 1 PS* = 1 UNIT PG = 102 Color of handle DT Screw terminals Contacts for front plate mounting Order No. DT Spring-type terminals Price per PU Order No. Price per PU EMERGENCY-STOP devices according to ISO 13850, with yellow name plate, Ø 80 mm, with inscription EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbuttons, Ø 40 mm, with positive latching function With rotate-to-unlatch mechanism • German inscription "NOT-HALT" Red EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbutton with rotate-to-unlatch mechanism 1 NC 1) } 3SB3603-1HA20 B 3SB3603-1HA20-0CC0 1 NO + 1 NC 1) B 3SB3601-1HA20 B 3SB3601-1HA20-0CC0 1 NC + 1 NC 1) - B 3SB3611-1HA20-0CC0 1 NC 1) B 3SB3603-1HR20 -- 1 NO + 1 NC 1) B 3SB3601-1HR20 -- 1 NC 1) B 3SB3603-1HP20 -- 1 NO + 1 NC 1) B 3SB3601-1HP20 -- 1 NC 1) } 3SB3603-1HA26 B 3SB3603-1HA26-0CC0 1 NO + 1 NC 1) B 3SB3601-1HA26 B 3SB3601-1HA26-0CC0 1 NC 1) B 3SB3603-1HR26 -- 1 NO + 1 NC 1) B 3SB3601-1HR26 -- 1 NC 1) B 3SB3603-1TA20 B 3SB3603-1TA20-0CC0 1 NO + 1 NC 1) B 3SB3601-1TA20 B 3SB3601-1TA20-0CC0 1 NC + 1 NC 1) -- B 3SB3611-1TA20-0CC0 1 NC 1) B 3SB3603-1TR20 -- 1 NO + 1 NC 1) B 3SB3601-1TR20 -- 1 NC 1) B 3SB3603-1TP20 -- 1 NO + 1 NC 1) B 3SB3601-1TP20 -- • English inscription "EMERGENCY STOP" Red • French inscription "ARRET D’URGENCE" Red With rotate-to-unlatch mechanism and mechanical switch position indication • German inscription "NOT-HALT" Red • English inscription "EMERGENCY STOP" Red EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbutton with rotate-to-unlatch mechanism and switch position indication 10 With pull-to-unlatch mechanism, solvent-resistant2) • German inscription "NOT-HALT" Red EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbutton with pull-to-unlatch mechanism • English inscription "EMERGENCY STOP" Red • French inscription "ARRET D’URGENCE" Red 1) Positive opening according to IEC 60947-5-1, Appendix K. Can be used with 3TK28 safety relays. Certificate: 2) Not suitable for laser inscription. * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/51 © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Actuators and Indicators, Metal, Round, 22 mm Complete units PU (UNIT) = 1 PS* = 1 UNIT PG = 102 Rated voltage of lamp Color of lens DT Screw terminals Order No. V DT Spring-type terminals Price per PU Order No. Price per PU Indicator lights Indicator lights with lens with concentric rings1) With integrated LED 24 AC/DC Red Yellow Green Blue White Clear } B } B B } 3SB3644-6BA20 3SB3644-6BA30 3SB3644-6BA40 3SB3644-6BA50 3SB3644-6BA60 3SB3644-6BA70 C C C C C C 3SB3644-6BA20-0CC0 3SB3644-6BA30-0CC0 3SB3644-6BA40-0CC0 3SB3644-6BA50-0CC0 3SB3644-6BA60-0CC0 3SB3644-6BA70-0CC0 110 AC Red Yellow Green Blue White Clear B B B B B B 3SB3648-6BA20 3SB3648-6BA30 3SB3648-6BA40 3SB3648-6BA50 3SB3648-6BA60 3SB3648-6BA70 B B B B B B 3SB3648-6BA20-0CC0 3SB3648-6BA30-0CC0 3SB3648-6BA40-0CC0 3SB3648-6BA50-0CC0 3SB3648-6BA60-0CC0 3SB3648-6BA70-0CC0 230 AC Red Yellow Green Blue White Clear } B } B B } 3SB3652-6BA20 3SB3652-6BA30 3SB3652-6BA40 3SB3652-6BA50 3SB3652-6BA60 3SB3652-6BA70 C C C C C C 3SB3652-6BA20-0CC0 3SB3652-6BA30-0CC0 3SB3652-6BA40-0CC0 3SB3652-6BA50-0CC0 3SB3652-6BA60-0CC0 3SB3652-6BA70-0CC0 B B B B B B 3SB3604-6BA20 3SB3604-6BA30 3SB3604-6BA40 3SB3604-6BA50 3SB3604-6BA60 3SB3604-6BA70 C C C C C C 3SB3604-6BA20-0CC0 3SB3604-6BA30-0CC0 3SB3604-6BA40-0CC0 3SB3604-6BA50-0CC0 3SB3604-6BA60-0CC0 3SB3604-6BA70-0CC0 Indicator light With BA 9s lampholder, without lamp -- Inscription by inserting a label is not possible. 10 1) Red Yellow Green Blue White Clear 10/52 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Actuators and Indicators, Metal, Round, 22 mm Actuators and indicators ■ Selection and ordering data Version Inscriptions Color of handle DT Order No. Black Red Yellow Green Blue White Gray Clear2) } } B } B } B B Green Red White Black Blue Pushbuttons with flat solvent-resistant button3) Price per PU PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG 3SB3500-0AA11 3SB3500-0AA21 3SB3500-0AA31 3SB3500-0AA41 3SB3500-0AA51 3SB3500-0AA61 3SB3500-0AB51 3SB3500-0AA71 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 102 102 B B B B D 3SB3500-0AA81 3SB3500-0AB01 3SB3500-0AB11 3SB3500-0AB21 3SB3500-0AC81 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 Black Red Yellow Green Blue White } C C C C C 3SB3500-0AA11 3SB3500-0AA21-0PA0 3SB3500-0AA31-0PA0 3SB3500-0AA41-0PA0 3SB3500-0AA51-0PA0 3SB3500-0AA61-0PA0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 Pushbuttons with raised button Black Red Yellow Green Blue White B B B B B B 3SB3500-0BA11 3SB3500-0BA21 3SB3500-0BA31 3SB3500-0BA41 3SB3500-0BA51 3SB3500-0BA61 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 Pushbuttons with raised front ring (height 15.5 mm) Black Red Yellow Green Blue White B B B B B B 3SB3500-0AA12 3SB3500-0AA22 3SB3500-0AA32 3SB3500-0AA42 3SB3500-0AA52 3SB3500-0AA62 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 Illuminated pushbuttons with flat button (incl. holder for 3 elements) Amber2) Red2) Yellow2) Green2) Blue2) White Clear2) C } B } B B } 3SB3501-0AA01 3SB3501-0AA21 3SB3501-0AA31 3SB3501-0AA41 3SB3501-0AA51 3SB3501-0AA61 3SB3501-0AA71 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 102 Illuminated pushbuttons with flat, solvent-resistant button3) (incl. holder for 3 elements) Red2) Yellow2) Green2) Blue2) White Clear2) C C C C C C 3SB3501-0AA21-0PA0 3SB3501-0AA31-0PA0 3SB3501-0AA41-0PA0 3SB3501-0AA51-0PA0 3SB3501-0AA61-0PA0 3SB3501-0AA71-0PA0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 Illuminated pushbuttons with raised button (incl. holder for 3 elements) Amber Red Yellow Green Blue Clear D B B B B B 3SB3501-0BA01 3SB3501-0BA21 3SB3501-0BA31 3SB3501-0BA41 3SB3501-0BA51 3SB3501-0BA71 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 Pushbuttons with flat button, latching Unlatches by pressing again Black Red Yellow Green Blue White Gray B B B B B B D 3SB3500-0DA11 3SB3500-0DA21 3SB3500-0DA31 3SB3500-0DA41 3SB3500-0DA51 3SB3500-0DA61 3SB3500-0DB51 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 102 Illuminated pushbuttons with flat button, latching, Unlatches by pressing again, (incl. holder for 3 elements) Amber2) Red2) Yellow2) Green2) Blue2) White Clear2) D B B B B B B 3SB3501-0DA01 3SB3501-0DA21 3SB3501-0DA31 3SB3501-0DA41 3SB3501-0DA51 3SB3501-0DA61 3SB3501-0DA71 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 102 Pushbuttons with flat button Pushbutton with flat button I O I O R Pushbutton with raised button Pushbutton with raised front ring Illuminated pushbutton with flat button Illuminated pushbutton with raised button Pushbutton with flat button 1) Also available without holder. Supplement Order No. with "–Z" and quote order code "B01". 2) Inscription is possible by inserting a label. 3) Not suitable for laser inscription. * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/53 10 Pushbuttons with holder1) © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Actuators and Indicators, Metal, Round, 22 mm Actuators and indicators Version Color of handle DT Order No. Mushroom pushbuttons, Ø 30 mm Black Red Yellow Green B B B B Mushroom pushbuttons, Ø 40 mm Black Red Yellow Green Mushroom pushbuttons, Ø 60 mm Price per PU PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG 3SB3500-1DA11 3SB3500-1DA21 3SB3500-1DA31 3SB3500-1DA41 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 B B B B 3SB3500-1GA11 3SB3500-1GA21 3SB3500-1GA31 3SB3500-1GA41 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 Black Red Yellow Green B B B B 3SB3500-1QA11 3SB3500-1QA21 3SB3500-1QA31 3SB3500-1QA41 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 Illuminated mushroom pushbuttons, Ø 30 mm Amber (incl. holder for 3 elements) Yellow Green White B B B B 3SB3501-1DA01 3SB3501-1DA31 3SB3501-1DA41 3SB3501-1DA61 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 Illuminated mushroom pushbuttons, Ø 40 mm Amber (incl. holder for 3 elements) Yellow Green White B B B B 3SB3501-1GA01 3SB3501-1GA31 3SB3501-1GA41 3SB3501-1GA61 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 Illuminated mushroom pushbuttons, Ø 60 mm Amber (incl. holder for 3 elements) Yellow Green White B B B B 3SB3501-1QA01 3SB3501-1QA31 3SB3501-1QA41 3SB3501-1QA61 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 Push-pull buttons, Ø 30 mm, latching, pull to unlatch Black Red B B 3SB3500-1EA11 3SB3500-1EA21 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 Push-pull buttons, Ø 40 mm, latching, pull to unlatch Black Red Yellow Green B B B C 3SB3500-1CA11 3SB3500-1CA21 3SB3500-1CA31 3SB3500-1CA41 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 Push-pull buttons, Ø 60 mm, latching, pull to unlatch Black Red B B 3SB3500-1RA11 3SB3500-1RA21 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 Push-pull buttons, Ø 30 mm, latching, pull to unlatch, can be illuminated (incl. holder for 3 elements) Amber Red Yellow Green Blue Clear C B B B B B 3SB3501-1EA01 3SB3501-1EA21 3SB3501-1EA31 3SB3501-1EA41 3SB3501-1EA51 3SB3501-1EA71 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 Push-pull buttons, Ø 40 mm, latching, pull to unlatch, can be illuminated (incl. holder for 3 elements) Amber Red Yellow Green Blue Clear C B B B B B 3SB3501-1CA01 3SB3501-1CA21 3SB3501-1CA31 3SB3501-1CA41 3SB3501-1CA51 3SB3501-1CA71 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 Push-pull buttons, Ø 60 mm, latching, pull to unlatch, can be illuminated (incl. holder for 3 elements) Amber Red Yellow Green Blue Clear C B B C B D 3SB3501-1RA01 3SB3501-1RA21 3SB3501-1RA31 3SB3501-1RA41 3SB3501-1RA51 3SB3501-1RA71 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 Mushroom pushbuttons with holder1) Mushroom pushbutton, Ø 30 mm Mushroom pushbutton, Ø 40 mm 10 Illuminated mushroom pushbutton, Ø 60 mm Push-pull button, Ø 30 mm Push-pull button, Ø 40 mm Push-pull button, Ø 60 mm, can be illuminated 1) Also available without holder. Supplement Order No. with "–Z" and quote order code "B01". 10/54 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Actuators and Indicators, Metal, Round, 22 mm Actuators and indicators Version Version Illumination Color of handle DT Order No. Black Red Green White } A C B Non-illuminated, with solvent-resistant knob1) Black Red Green Illuminated, standard version1) (incl. holder for 3 elements) Switching Non-illuminated, sequence O-I, standard version1) 50° operating angle, latching Price per PU PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG 3SB3500-2HA11 3SB3500-2HA21 3SB3500-2HA41 3SB3500-2HA61 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 B B B 3SB3500-2HA11-0PA0 3SB3500-2HA21-0PA0 3SB3500-2HA41-0PA0 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 Amber Red Yellow Green Blue Clear C C C C C C 3SB3501-2HA01 3SB3501-2HA21 3SB3501-2HA31 3SB3501-2HA41 3SB3501-2HA51 3SB3501-2HA71 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 Black Red Green White } B B B 3SB3500-2KA11 3SB3500-2KA21 3SB3500-2KA41 3SB3500-2KA61 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 Non-illuminated, with solvent-resistant knob1) Black Red Green D D B 3SB3500-2KA11-0PA0 3SB3500-2KA21-0PA0 3SB3500-2KA41-0PA0 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 Illuminated, standard version1) (incl. holder for 3 elements) Amber Red Yellow Green Blue Clear D B B B B B 3SB3501-2KA01 3SB3501-2KA21 3SB3501-2KA31 3SB3501-2KA41 3SB3501-2KA51 3SB3501-2KA71 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 Illuminated, with solvent-resistant knob1) (incl. holder for 3 elements) Red Green Blue Clear D D D D 3SB3501-2KA21-0PA0 3SB3501-2KA41-0PA0 3SB3501-2KA51-0PA0 3SB3501-2KA71-0PA0 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 Non-illuminated, heavy-duty version Black Red Green White C D D D 3SB3500-2PA11 3SB3500-2PA21 3SB3500-2PA41 3SB3500-2PA61 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 Illuminated, heavy-duty version (incl. holder for 3 elements) Amber Red Yellow Green Blue Clear D D D D D D 3SB3501-2PA01 3SB3501-2PA21 3SB3501-2PA31 3SB3501-2PA41 3SB3501-2PA51 3SB3501-2PA71 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 Non-illuminated, long handle Black Red Green White D D D D 3SB3500-3PA11 3SB3500-3PA21 3SB3500-3PA41 3SB3500-3PA61 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 Illuminated long handle (incl. holder for 3 elements) Red Yellow Green Blue Clear D D D D D 3SB3501-3PA21 3SB3501-3PA31 3SB3501-3PA41 3SB3501-3PA51 3SB3501-3PA71 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 Selector switches with holders Switching Non-illuminated, sequence O-I, standard version1) 90° operating angle, latching Selector switch, 2 switch positions, standard version, 90° Selector switch, 2 switch positions, standard version, 50° Selector switch, 2 switch positions, heavy-duty version Selector switch, 2 switch positions, long handle 1) Also available without holder. Supplement Order No. with "–Z" and quote order code "B01". * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/55 10 Selector switches with 2 switch positions © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Actuators and Indicators, Metal, Round, 22 mm Actuators and indicators Version Version Illumination Color of handle DT Order No. Black Red Green White } B B B Black Red Green Illuminated, standard version1) (incl. holder for 3 elements) Price per PU PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG 3SB3500-2LA11 3SB3500-2LA21 3SB3500-2LA41 3SB3500-2LA61 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 B B B 3SB3500-2LA11-0PA0 3SB3500-2LA21-0PA0 3SB3500-2LA41-0PA0 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 Amber Red Yellow Green Blue Clear D B B B B B 3SB3501-2LA01 3SB3501-2LA21 3SB3501-2LA31 3SB3501-2LA41 3SB3501-2LA51 3SB3501-2LA71 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 Illuminated, with solvent-resistant knob1) (incl. holder for 3 elements) Red Green Blue Clear D D D B 3SB3501-2LA21-0PA0 3SB3501-2LA41-0PA0 3SB3501-2LA51-0PA0 3SB3501-2LA71-0PA0 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 Non-illuminated, heavy-duty version Black Red Green White D D D D 3SB3500-2QA11 3SB3500-2QA21 3SB3500-2QA41 3SB3500-2QA61 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 Illuminated, heavy-duty version (incl. holder for 3 elements) Amber Red Yellow Green Blue Clear D D D D D D 3SB3501-2QA01 3SB3501-2QA21 3SB3501-2QA31 3SB3501-2QA41 3SB3501-2QA51 3SB3501-2QA71 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 Non-illuminated, long handle Black Red Green D D D 3SB3500-3QA11 3SB3500-3QA21 3SB3500-3QA41 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 Illuminated long handle (incl. holder for 3 elements) Red Yellow Green Blue Clear D D D D D 3SB3501-3QA21 3SB3501-3QA31 3SB3501-3QA41 3SB3501-3QA51 3SB3501-3QA71 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 Selector switches with holders Selector switches with 2 switch positions Switching Non-illuminated, sequence O-I, standard version1) 50° operating angle, momentary contact type Non-illuminated, with solvent-resistant knob1) Selector switch, 2 switch positions, standard version Selector switch, 2 switch positions, heavy-duty version Selector switch, 2 switch positions, long handle 10 1) Also available without holder. Supplement Order No. with "–Z" and quote order code "B01". 10/56 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Actuators and Indicators, Metal, Round, 22 mm Actuators and indicators Version Version Illumination Color of handle DT Order No. Non-illuminated, standard version1) Black Red Green White } B B B Non-illuminated, with solvent-resistant knob1) Black Red Green Illuminated, standard version 1) (incl. holder for 3 elements) Price per PU PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG 3SB3500-2DA11 3SB3500-2DA21 3SB3500-2DA41 3SB3500-2DA61 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 B B B 3SB3500-2DA11-0PA0 3SB3500-2DA21-0PA0 3SB3500-2DA41-0PA0 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 Amber Red Yellow Green Blue Clear D B B B B B 3SB3501-2DA01 3SB3501-2DA21 3SB3501-2DA31 3SB3501-2DA41 3SB3501-2DA51 3SB3501-2DA71 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 Illuminated, with solvent-resistant knob1) (incl. holder for 3 elements) Red Green Blue Clear B D B D 3SB3501-2DA21-0PA0 3SB3501-2DA41-0PA0 3SB3501-2DA51-0PA0 3SB3501-2DA71-0PA0 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 Non-illuminated, heavy-duty version Black Red Green White C D D D 3SB3500-2SA11 3SB3500-2SA21 3SB3500-2SA41 3SB3500-2SA61 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 Illuminated, heavy-duty version (incl. holder for 3 elements) Amber Red Yellow Green Blue Clear D D D D D D 3SB3501-2SA01 3SB3501-2SA21 3SB3501-2SA31 3SB3501-2SA41 3SB3501-2SA51 3SB3501-2SA71 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 Non-illuminated, long handle Black Red Green White D D D D 3SB3500-3SA11 3SB3500-3SA21 3SB3500-3SA41 3SB3500-3SA61 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 Illuminated long handle (incl. holder for 3 elements) Red Yellow Green Blue Clear D D D D D 3SB3501-3SA21 3SB3501-3SA31 3SB3501-3SA41 3SB3501-3SA51 3SB3501-3SA71 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 Non-illuminated, standard version1) Black Red Green White } B B B 3SB3500-2EA11 3SB3500-2EA21 3SB3500-2EA41 3SB3500-2EA61 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 Non-illuminated, with solvent-resistant knob1) Black Red Green B B B 3SB3500-2EA11-0PA0 3SB3500-2EA21-0PA0 3SB3500-2EA41-0PA0 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 Illuminated, standard version1) (incl. holder for 3 elements) Amber Red Yellow Green Blue Clear D B B B B B 3SB3501-2EA01 3SB3501-2EA21 3SB3501-2EA31 3SB3501-2EA41 3SB3501-2EA51 3SB3501-2EA71 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 Illuminated, with solvent-resistant knob1) (incl. holder for 3 elements) Red Green Blue Clear B B B D 3SB3501-2EA21-0PA0 3SB3501-2EA41-0PA0 3SB3501-2EA51-0PA0 3SB3501-2EA71-0PA0 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 Selector switches with holders Switching sequence I-O-II, 2 x 50° operating angle, latching Selector switch, 3 switch positions, standard version Selector switch, 3 switch positions, heavy-duty version Selector switch, 3 switch positions, long handle Switching sequence I-O-II, 2 x 50° operating angle, momentary contact type 1) Also available without holder. Supplement Order No. with "–Z" and quote order code "B01". * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/57 10 Selector switches with 3 switch positions © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Actuators and Indicators, Metal, Round, 22 mm Actuators and indicators Version Version Illumination Color of handle DT Order No. Non-illuminated, heavy-duty version Black Red Green White C D D D Illuminated, heavy-duty version (incl. holder for 3 elements) Amber Red Yellow Green Blue Clear Non-illuminated, long handle Price per PU PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG 3SB3500-2TA11 3SB3500-2TA21 3SB3500-2TA41 3SB3500-2TA61 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 D D D D D D 3SB3501-2TA01 3SB3501-2TA21 3SB3501-2TA31 3SB3501-2TA41 3SB3501-2TA51 3SB3501-2TA71 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 Black Red Green White D D D D 3SB3500-3TA11 3SB3500-3TA21 3SB3500-3TA41 3SB3500-3TA61 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 Illuminated long handle (incl. holder for 3 elements) Red Yellow Green Blue Clear D D D D D 3SB3501-3TA21 3SB3501-3TA31 3SB3501-3TA41 3SB3501-3TA51 3SB3501-3TA71 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 Non-illuminated, standard version1) Black Red Green White B B B B 3SB3500-2GA11 3SB3500-2GA21 3SB3500-2GA41 3SB3500-2GA61 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 Illuminated, standard version1) (incl. holder for 3 elements) Amber Red Yellow Green Blue Clear D D D B D D 3SB3501-2GA01 3SB3501-2GA21 3SB3501-2GA31 3SB3501-2GA41 3SB3501-2GA51 3SB3501-2GA71 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 Non-illuminated, heavy-duty version Black Red Green White D D D D 3SB3500-2VA11 3SB3500-2VA21 3SB3500-2VA41 3SB3500-2VA61 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 Illuminated, heavy-duty version Amber Red Yellow Green Blue Clear D D D D D D 3SB3501-2VA01 3SB3501-2VA21 3SB3501-2VA31 3SB3501-2VA41 3SB3501-2VA51 3SB3501-2VA71 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 Non-illuminated, long handle Black Red D D 3SB3500-3VA11 3SB3500-3VA21 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 Non-illuminated, standard version1) Black Red Green White B D B B 3SB3500-2FA11 3SB3500-2FA21 3SB3500-2FA41 3SB3500-2FA61 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 Illuminated, standard version1) (incl. holder for 3 elements) Amber Red Yellow Green Blue Clear D D D B D B 3SB3501-2FA01 3SB3501-2FA21 3SB3501-2FA31 3SB3501-2FA41 3SB3501-2FA51 3SB3501-2FA71 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 Non-illuminated, heavy-duty version Black Red Green White D D D D 3SB3500-2UA11 3SB3500-2UA21 3SB3500-2UA41 3SB3500-2UA61 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 Illuminated, heavy-duty version Amber Red Yellow Green Blue Clear D D D D D D 3SB3501-2UA01 3SB3501-2UA21 3SB3501-2UA31 3SB3501-2UA41 3SB3501-2UA51 3SB3501-2UA71 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 Non-illuminated, long handle Black Red Green White D D D D 3SB3500-3UA11 3SB3500-3UA21 3SB3500-3UA41 3SB3500-3UA61 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 Selector switches with holders Selector switches with 3 switch positions Switching sequence I-O-II, 2 x 50° operating angle, momentary contact type Selector switch, 3 switch positions, standard version Selector switch, 3 switch positions, heavy-duty version Switching sequence I-O-II, 2 x 50° operating angle, momentary contact type to the left, latching to the right 10 Selector switch, 3 switch positions, long handle Switching sequence I-O-II, 2 x 50° operating angle, latching to the left, momentary contact type to the right 1) Also available without holder. Supplement Order No. with "–Z" and quote order code "B01". 10/58 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Actuators and Indicators, Metal, Round, 22 mm Actuators and indicators Version Lock version Type DT Order No. Lock No./ Key color removal position Price per PU PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG Key-operated switches with holder1) SB 30 O+I O I } } B 3SB3500-4AD11 3SB3500-4AD01 3SB3500-4AD21 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 SSG 10 O+I O I } } B 3SB3500-4LD11 3SB3500-4LD01 3SB3500-4LD21 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 LSG 1 O+I O B B 3SB3500-4LF01 3SB3500-4LF11 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 S1 O+I O B B 3SB3500-5AD11 3SB3500-5AD01 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 E1 for VW2) O B 3SB3500-5AE11 1 1 unit 102 E2 for VW2) O+I O B B 3SB3500-5AE21 3SB3500-5AE31 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 E7 for VW2) O+I O B B 3SB3500-5AE41 3SB3500-5AE51 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 E9 for VW2) O B 3SB3500-5AE71 1 1 unit 102 73038 O+I Light blue O I B B B 3SB3500-3AG11 3SB3500-3AG01 3SB3500-3AG21 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 73037 Red O+I O I B B B 3SB3500-3AH11 3SB3500-3AH01 3SB3500-3AH21 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 73034 Black O+I O I B B B 3SB3500-3AJ11 3SB3500-3AJ01 3SB3500-3AJ21 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 73033 Yellow O+I O I B B B 3SB3500-3AK11 3SB3500-3AK01 3SB3500-3AK21 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 SB 30 O } 3SB3500-4BD01 1 1 unit 102 SSG 10 O } 3SB3500-4MD01 1 1 unit 102 LSG 1 O B 3SB3500-4MF11 1 1 unit 102 BKS S1 O B 3SB3500-5BD01 1 1 unit 102 O.M.R.3) 73038 O Light blue B 3SB3500-3BG01 1 1 unit 102 73037 Red O B 3SB3500-3BH01 1 1 unit 102 73034 Black O B 3SB3500-3BJ01 1 1 unit 102 73033 Yellow O B 3SB3500-3BK01 1 1 unit 102 Switching sequence O-I, RONIS 50° operating angle, latching CES RONIS key-operated switch BKS CES key-operated switch O.M.R.3) BKS key-operated switch Switching sequence O-I, RONIS 50° operating angle, CES momentary contact type O.M.R. key-operated switch For BKS and CES special locks, see page 10/69. 1) Also available without holder. Supplement Order No. with "–Z" and quote order code "B01". 2) Keys are not included in scope of supply. 3) According to FIAT standards; also available for other users. * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/59 10 Key-operated switches with 2 keys, 2 switch positions © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Actuators and Indicators, Metal, Round, 22 mm Actuators and indicators Version Lock version Type DT Order No. Lock No./ Key color removal position Price per PU PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG Key-operated switches with holder1) Key-operated switches with 2 keys, 3 switch positions SB 30 I+O+II O I+II I II O+I B B B B B B 3SB3500-4DD11 3SB3500-4DD01 3SB3500-4DD41 3SB3500-4DD21 3SB3500-4DD31 3SB3500-4DD51 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 CES SSG 10 O+I+II O I+II I II B B B B B 3SB3500-4PD11 3SB3500-4PD01 3SB3500-4PD41 3SB3500-4PD21 3SB3500-4PD31 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 BKS S1 O I+II C C 3SB3500-5DD01 3SB3500-5DD41 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 O.M.R.2) 73038 I+O+II Light blue B 3SB3500-3DG11 1 1 unit 102 73037 Red I+O+II B 3SB3500-3DH11 1 1 unit 102 73034 Black I+O+II O B B 3SB3500-3DJ11 3SB3500-3DJ01 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 Switching sequence I-O-II, RONIS 2 x 50° operating angle, CES momentary contact type BKS SB 30 O B 3SB3500-4ED01 1 1 unit 102 SSG 10 O B 3SB3500-4QD01 1 1 unit 102 S1 O B 3SB3500-5ED01 1 1 unit 102 O.M.R. 73034 Black O B 3SB3500-3EJ01 1 1 unit 102 Switching sequence I-O-II, RONIS 2 x 50° operating angle, momentary contact type to CES the left, latching to the right SB 30 O + II O B B 3SB3500-4GD61 3SB3500-4GD01 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 SSG 10 O + II O II B B B 3SB3500-4SD61 3SB3500-4SD01 3SB3500-4SD31 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 BKS S1 O + II O C C 3SB3500-5GD61 3SB3500-5GD01 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 O.M.R. 73033 Yellow II C 3SB3500-3GK31 1 1 unit 102 Switching sequence I-O-II, RONIS 2 x 50° operating angle, CES latching to the left, momentary contact type to the right BKS SB 30 O+I B 3SB3500-4FD51 1 1 unit 102 SSG 10 O+I O I B B B 3SB3500-4RD51 3SB3500-4RD01 3SB3500-4RD21 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 S1 O+I O I C B B 3SB3500-5FD51 3SB3500-5FD01 3SB3500-5FD21 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 Switching sequence I-O-II, RONIS 2 x 50° operating angle, latching RONIS key-operated switch CES key-operated switch 10 BKS key-operated switch O.M.R. key-operated switch For BKS and CES special locks, see page 10/69. 1) Also available without holder. Supplement Order No. with "–Z" and quote order code "B01". 2) According to FIAT standards; also available for other users. 10/60 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Actuators and Indicators, Metal, Round, 22 mm Actuators and indicators Version Color of handle Approval DT Order No. Price per PU PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG EMERGENCY-STOP devices according to ISO 13850 and IEC 60947-5-5 with holder1)2). Can also be used with 3TK28 safety relays. EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbuttons, Ø 32 mm With positive latching acc. to ISO 13850, with rotate-to-unlatch mechanism • Standard version B 3SB3500-1FA20 1 1 unit 102 • Solvent-resistant3) B 3SB3500-1FA20-0PA0 1 1 unit 102 • Without switch position indicator } 3SB3500-1HA20 1 1 unit 102 • Without switch position indicator, solvent-resistant3) B 3SB3500-1HA20-0PA0 1 1 unit 102 A 3SB3500-1HA26 1 1 unit 102 B 3SB3500-1TA20 1 1 unit 102 Mushroom diameter 32 mm EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbuttons, Ø 40 mm With positive latching acc. to ISO 13850, with rotate-to-unlatch mechanism Red Mushroom diameter 40 mm, • With mechanical switch position indication with rotate-to-unlatch mechanism with switch position indication With pull-to-unlatch mechanism Mushroom diameter 40 mm, pull-to-unlatch mechanism Red B 3SB3500-1AA20 1 1 unit 102 EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbuttons, Ø 40 mm, with RONIS key-operated switch, (with 2 keys), lock No. SB 30, with positive latching according to ISO 13850, unlocking only possible using key Red B 3SB3500-1BA20 1 1 unit 102 EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom Red pushbuttons, Ø 40 mm, with CES key-operated switch, (with 2 keys), Mushroom diameter 40 mm, lock No. SSG 10, with positive latching with RONIS key-operated according to ISO 13850, switch unlocking only possible using key B 3SB3500-1KA20 1 1 unit 102 Red B 3SB3500-1LA20 1 1 unit 102 Red B 3SB3500-1MA20 1 1 unit 102 10 EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbuttons, Ø 60 mm With positive latching acc. to ISO 13850, with rotate-to-unlatch mechanism Mushroom diameter 60 mm EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbuttons, Ø 40 mm, with BKS key-operated switch, (with 2 keys), lock No. S1, with positive latching according to ISO 13850, unlocking only possible using key EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbuttons, Ø 40 mm, with O.M.R. key-operated switch (with 2 keys), lock No. 73037, Mushroom diameter 40 mm, with positive latching according to ISO 13850, unlocking only possible with CES key-operated using key switch For BKS and CES special locks, see page 10/69. * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate 1) Also available without holder. Supplement Order No. with "–Z" and quote order code "B01". 2) The yellow backing plates must be ordered separately, see Accessories. 3) Not suitable for laser inscription. Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/61 © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Actuators and Indicators, Metal, Round, 22 mm Actuators and indicators Version Color of lens DT Order No. Indicator lights with lens with concentric rings2) Amber Red Yellow Green Blue White Clear B } B } B B } Indicator lights with smooth lens2) Amber Red Yellow Green Blue White Clear Indicator lights with smooth solvent-resistant lens2)3) Red Yellow Green Blue White Clear Price per PU PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG 3SB3501-6BA00 3SB3501-6BA20 3SB3501-6BA30 3SB3501-6BA40 3SB3501-6BA50 3SB3501-6BA60 3SB3501-6BA70 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 102 B B B B B } B 3SB3501-6AA00 3SB3501-6AA20 3SB3501-6AA30 3SB3501-6AA40 3SB3501-6AA50 3SB3501-6AA60 3SB3501-6AA70 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 102 C C C C C C 3SB3501-6AA20-0PA0 3SB3501-6AA30-0PA0 3SB3501-6AA40-0PA0 3SB3501-6AA50-0PA0 3SB3501-6AA60-0PA0 3SB3501-6AA70-0PA0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 102 Signaling elements with holder1) Indicator light with smooth lens Also available without holder. Supplement Order No. with "–Z" and quote order code "B01". 2) Inscription by inserting a label is not possible. 3) Not suitable for laser inscription. 10 1) 10/62 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Components for Actuators and Indicators Contact blocks and lampholders ■ Selection and ordering data Version Diagram DT Screw terminals Operating travel PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG 3SB3400-0B 1 1 unit 102 3SB3400-0BA 1 1 unit 102 3SB3400-0C 1 1 unit 102 3SB3400-0CA 1 1 unit 102 B 3SB3400-0M 1 1 unit 102 } 3SB3400-0A 1 1 unit 102 B 3SB3400-0AA 1 1 unit 102 D 3SB3400-0N 1 1 unit 102 Contact closed Order No. Contact open Price per PU Contact blocks for front plate mounting Contact blocks with one contact • Mounting depth: 50 mm 3 NSD0_00015 NSD00006 1 NO 1 NO with gold-plated contacts 3-4 0 1 mm 4 1 NC 1) 1 NC with gold-plated contacts 1) 1 2 1-2 0 1 mm • With mounting monitoring contact2), mounting depth 63 mm 4 2,3 2 3 4 1,6 NSD0_00017 1-2 0 1 mm 1) 1 NC 3 NSD0_00017 NSD00007 3SB34 00-0B 2 3SB34 00-0M 2 3 4 1,6 Contact blocks with 2 contacts Mounting depth 63 mm (including unit labeling plate) 1) 1 NO + 1 NC with dust protection3) 1) 31 1 NO leading + 1 NC lagging 3SB34 00-0A 75 1 NO leading + 1 NC lagging with gold-plated contacts 86 2 NO 3 3 NSD00034 42 2 NO with gold-plated contacts 2 NO with dust protection3) 4 4 NSD00038 3-4 1-2 0 1 2 3 mm 1,6 2,3 4 NSD00037b 7-8 5-6 0 1 2 3 mm 1,3 2,2 NSD00039 2 3 3SB3400-0H 1 1 unit 102 3SB3400-0HA 1 1 unit 102 B 3SB3400-0D 1 1 unit 102 B 3SB3400-0DA 1 1 unit 102 C 3SB3400-0P 1 1 unit 102 B 3SB3400-0E 1 1 unit 102 B 3SB3400-0EA 1 1 unit 102 C 3SB3400-0Q 1 1 unit 102 B 3SB3400-2A 1 1 unit 102 4 3-4 3-4 0 1 mm B D 4 1) 2 NC with gold-plated contacts 1) 3) 2 NC with dust protection 1 1 2 2 1) NSD00036 2,3 2 NC NSD00040 1-2 1-2 0 1 mm 2 3 4 1,6 Blocks with 2 diodes type 1N 4007 Mounting depth: 63 mm URMS = max. 250 V IFAV = 0.8 A at Tu = 60 °C (L+) X5 X7 (L-) X6 X8 NSD00113 3SB34 00-2A 1) Positive opening according to IEC 60947-5-1, Appendix K. 2) The NC contact opens automatically upon disconnection of the actuator. On delivery, the contact is open (= safe state). Activation (= NC contacts on the non-actuated control device are closed) takes place upon first-time actuation after the contact block is snapped onto the actuator. Unsuitable for mounting in 3SB38 enclosures. 3) With 3SB30 01-0CH dust protection shield * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/63 10 1 NO + 1 NC with goldplated contacts NSD00033 1) NSD00035 1 NO + 1 NC © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Components for Actuators and Indicators Contact blocks and lampholders Version Diagram Rated voltage of lamp DT Screw terminals Order No. V PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG Price per PU Contact blocks for front plate mounting BA 9s lampholders, mounting depth 50 mm Without lamp With 24 V incandescent lamp (3SX1 344) X1 (L+) X2 (L-) Acc. to lamp } 3SB3400-1A 1 1 unit 102 24 AC/DC B 3SB3400-1D 1 1 unit 102 110/130 AC/DC B 3SB3400-1B 1 1 unit 102 230/240 AC B 3SB3400-1C 1 1 unit 102 230/240 AC B 3SB3400-1F 1 1 unit 102 Acc. to lamp B 3SB3400-1G 1 1 unit 102 Acc. to lamp B 3SB3400-1L 1 1 unit 102 Acc. to lamp B 3SB3400-1H 1 1 unit 102 24 AC/DC B } } B } 3SB3400-1PA 3SB3400-1PB 3SB3400-1PC 3SB3400-1PD 3SB3400-1PE 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 110 AC B B B B B 3SB3400-1QA 3SB3400-1QB 3SB3400-1QC 3SB3400-1QD 3SB3400-1QE 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 230 AC B } } B } 3SB3400-1RA 3SB3400-1RB 3SB3400-1RC 3SB3400-1RD 3SB3400-1RE 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 127 / 24 240 / 24 260 / 24 400 / 24 B B D B 3SB3400-3A 3SB3400-3C 3SB3400-3E 3SB3400-3F 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 127 / 6 240 / 6 400 / 6 480 / 6 600 / 6 B B B B D 3SB3400-3M 3SB3400-3P 3SB3400-3S 3SB3400-3U 3SB3400-3W 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 NSD00003 BA 9s lampholders, mounting depth 50 mm 3SB34 00-1A With built-in resistor for longer endurance and with 130 V lamp (3SX1 731)1) X1 (L+) With integrated voltage reducer and with 130 V lamp (3SX1 731)1) X1 X2 (L-) NSD00041 X2 NSD00042 BA 9s lampholders With separate lamp test function2)3) With integrated voltage reducer and with 130 V lamp (3SX1 731)1) X5 X1 X2 NSD00043 Without lamp For incandescent lamp, max. 2.6 W; for LED lamp, 24/48/230 V AC/DC4) 3SB34 00-1F Without lamp For incandescent lamp, max. 2.6 W; for LED lamp, AC or DC5) Without lamp For incandescent lamp, max. 2.6 W; for glow lamp, AC AC/DC-LED X5 X1 (L+) X2 (L-) NSD0_00044b X5 X2 X1 (L-) (L+) NSD00045 X5 X1 (L+) X2 (L-) NSD0_00046a 10 Lampholders with integrated LED Mounting depth: 50 mm 3SB34 00-1PA Yellow Red Green Blue White X1 Yellow Red Green Blue White X1 X2 k k + NSD0_01292b k k + X2 NSD0_01296b Yellow Red Green Blue White X1 k k + X2 NSD0_01296b Transformers For snapping onto 3SB34 00-1A lampholder For incandescent lamp AC, max. 2 W X1 X2 NSD00047 Mounting depth: 97 mm 3SB34 00-3. 1) Use these lamps only. 4) Not suitable for LEDs which are suitable only for AC or DC. 2) The lampholder with separate lamp test function can not be installed in an enclosure. 5) Not suitable for LED for 24/48/230 V AC/DC. For connecting to DC, X5 must be connected to L–. 3) For circuit examples see note on Technical Information on page 3/1. 10/64 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Components for Actuators and Indicators Contact blocks and lampholders Version Rated voltage of lamp/ Diagram V Operating travel/color DT Spring-type terminals Contact closed Order No. Contact open PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG Price per PU Contact blocks for front plate mounting Contact blocks with one contact, mounting depth 50 mm 3 NSD0_00015 NSD00006 1 NO 1 NO with gold-plated contacts 3-4 0 1 mm 4 1) 1 NC with gold-plated contacts 1) 1 2 1-2 0 1 mm • With mounting monitoring contact2), mounting depth 63 mm 1 NC 3 4 3SB3403-0B 1 1 unit 102 3SB3403-0BA 1 1 unit 102 B 3SB3403-0C 1 1 unit 102 B 3SB3403-0CA 1 1 unit 102 B 3SB3403-0M 1 1 unit 102 B 3SB3403-0A 1 1 unit 102 B 3SB3403-0AA 1 1 unit 102 B 3SB3403-0H 1 1 unit 102 B 3SB3403-0HA 1 1 unit 102 2,3 NSD0_00017 NSD00007 3SB34 03-0B 1 NC 2 B B 2 3 4 1,6 NSD0_00017 1-2 0 1 mm 1) 2 3 4 1,6 Contact blocks with 2 contacts, mounting depth 63 mm 31 3-4 1-2 7-8 5-6 42 1 NO leading + 1 NC lagging 75 1 NO leading + 1 NC lagging with gold-plated contacts 86 2 NO 3 3 NSD00038 NSD00033 1) NSD00034 1) 0 1 2 3 mm 1,6 2,3 2 NO with gold-plated contacts 4 4 4 NSD00037b 0 1 2 3 mm 1,3 2,2 4 B 3SB3403-0D 1 1 unit 102 D 3SB3403-0DA 1 1 unit 102 B 3SB3403-0E 1 1 unit 102 D 3SB3403-0EA 1 1 unit 102 B 3SB3403-1A 1 1 unit 102 B 3SB3403-1C 1 1 unit 102 Yellow Red Green Blue White B B B B B 3SB3403-1PA 3SB3403-1PB 3SB3403-1PC 3SB3403-1PD 3SB3403-1PE 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 Yellow Red Green Blue White B B B B B 3SB3403-1QA 3SB3403-1QB 3SB3403-1QC 3SB3403-1QD 3SB3403-1QE 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 Yellow Red Green Blue White B B B B B 3SB3403-1RA 3SB3403-1RB 3SB3403-1RC 3SB3403-1RD 3SB3403-1RE 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 NSD00039 NSD00035 3-4 3-4 0 1 mm 3SB34 03-0A 2 3 4 2,3 1) 2 NC with gold-plated contacts 1) 1 1 2 2 NSD00040 NSD00036 2 NC 1-2 1-2 0 1 mm 2 3 4 10 3SB34 03-0M 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC with gold-plated contacts 1,6 BA 9s lampholders, mounting depth 50 mm Without lamp3) Acc. to lamp X1 (L+) X2 (L-) NSD00003 3SB34 03-1C With integrated voltage reducer and with 130 V lamp (3SX1 731)3)4) 230/240 V AC Lampholders with integrated LED 24 V AC/DC Mounting depth: 50 mm X2 X1 NSD00042 X1 k X2 k + NSD0_01292b 110 V AC X1 k 3SB3403-1PA k + X2 NSD0_01296b 230 V AC X1 k k + X2 NSD0_01296b 1) Positive opening according to IEC 60947-5-1, Appendix K. 3) Not suitable for square command devices. 2) The NC contact opens automatically upon disconnection of the actuator. On delivery, the contact is open (= safe state). For more explanations see footnote on page 10/63. Unsuitable for mounting in 3SB38 enclosures. 4) Use these lamps only. * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/65 © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Components for Actuators and Indicators Contact blocks and lampholders Version Diagram DT Solder pin connections Operating travel Contact closed Order No. Contact open PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG Price per PU Contact blocks for use on printed circuit boards 1 NO 3 NSD00006 Contact blocks with one contact Mounting depth 44 mm 1 NC 1) 1 3SB34 11-0B 2 NSD00007 4 NSD0_00015 3-4 0 1 mm X1 (L+) 3 3SB3411-0B 1 1 unit 102 B 3SB3411-0C 1 1 unit 102 B 3SB3411-1A 1 1 unit 102 PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG 4 2,3 NSD0_00017 1-2 0 1 mm Wedge base lampholders W2 x 4.6 d Mounting depth: 44 mm Without lamp 2 B 2 3 4 1,6 X2 (L-) NSD00003 3SB34 11-1A 1) Positive opening according to IEC 60947-5-1, Appendix K. Version DT Order No. Price per PU Holders for 3 contact blocks, for front panel mounting } 3SB3901-0AB 100 20 units 102 Holders for selector switches, key-operated switches and twin } pushbuttons With pressure plate for actuating the central contact block of 3 contact blocks 3SB3901-0AC 100 10 units 102 3SB3901-0AW 100 10 units 102 3SB3901-0AA 100 10 units 102 Holders for pushbuttons and switches1) For snapping on 3 blocks (for illuminated pushbuttons and illuminated selector switches the holder is included in the scope of supply) 10 3SB39 01-0AB 3SB39 01-0AC Pressure plates for use on printed circuit boards Pressure plates for selector switches and key-operated switches B For actuating the central contact block of 3 contact blocks 3SB39 01-0AW Accessories for printed circuit boards Holders for printed circuit boards For mounting the command devices on the printed circuit board (screw is included in the scope of supply) B 3SB39 01-0AA 1) Holder also for mushroom pushbutton and push-pull button. 10/66 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Components for Actuators and Indicators AS-Interface F adapters for EMERGENCY-STOP devices ■ Overview The AS-Interface F adapter is used to connect an EMERGENCYSTOP device according to ISO 13850 from the 3SB3 series to the AS-Interface bus system. The F adapter is suitable for control devices with mounting on front plates. The F adapter has a safe AS-Interface 2E slave and is snapped from behind onto the EMERGENCY-STOP device (actuator). In the 2E/1A expanded version, an output is also available for actuating an indicator light with LED. Depending on the version, screw terminals or spring-type terminals or the insulation piercing method are used for connecting to the AS-Interface bus cable. Addressing is performed using the AS-Interface connection or the integrated addressing socket. Safety category 4 (SIL 3) is achieved with the adapter. EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbutton with F adapter for bus connection ■ Selection and ordering data Version DT Screw terminals Order No. PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG Price per PU AS-Interface F adapters for 3SB3 EMERGENCY-STOP actuators For mounting on front plate • 2I } 3SF5402-1AA03 1 1 unit 121 • 2I/1O, with output for LED control } 3SF5402-1AB03 1 1 unit 121 Version DT Spring-type terminals PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG Order No. Price per PU AS-Interface F adapters for 3SB3 EMERGENCY-STOP actuators For mounting on front plate • 2I } 3SF5402-1AA04 1 1 unit 121 • 2I/1O, with output for LED control } 3SF5402-1AB04 1 1 unit 121 Version DT Insulation piercing method PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG 3SF5 402-1AA04 Order No. Price per PU AS-Interface F adapters for 3SB3 EMERGENCY-STOP actuators For mounting on front plate • 2I X 3SF5402-1AA05 1 1 unit 121 • 2I/1O, with output for LED control X 3SF5402-1AB05 1 1 unit 121 3SF5 402-1AA05 * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/67 10 3SF5 402-1AA03 © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Components for Actuators and Indicators Special locks ■ Options Special locks for key-operated switches Master and master-pass key systems The BKS and CES plastic and metal key-operated switches, round and square versions, can be optionally equipped with special locks. The following key systems can be supplied with BKS and CES key-operated switches: • Central lock systems • Master key systems • Central master key systems • Master-pass key systems In this case the Order No. of the matching key-operated switch must be supplemented with "-Z", the matching order code "Y01" or "Y02" and the required lock number. Order code Y01 Y02 In accordance with the table of special locks No Yes Normal delivery time 25 working days 5 working days Additional price per unit On request On request Ordering example 3SB30 00-4LD01-Z Y01 Z = SSG18 3SB30 00-4LD01-Z Y02 Z = SSG11 Available special locks with order code "Y02" When placing an order you must supplement the Order No. of the matching key-operated switches with "-Z" and quote the order code "Y03". Please enquire for price and delivery time. Order No. with order code Key-operated switches CES SSG 11 to SSG 15 10 BKS E1, E2, E7, E91) 3SB3. ..-4LD..-Z Y02 3SB3. ..-4MD01-Z Y02 3SB3. ..-4PD..-Z Y02 3SB3. ..-4QD..-Z Y02 3SB3. ..-4RD..-Z Y02 3SB3. ..-4SD..-Z Y02 3SB3. ..-5AD..-Z Y02 3SB3. ..-5BD01-Z Y02 3SB3. ..-5DD..-Z Y02 3SB3. ..-5ED01-Z Y02 3SB3. ..-5FD01-Z Y02 3SB3. ..-5GD01-Z Y02 Sub group key Master pass key Main group key NSD0_00075 Example of master-pass key system 3SB3. ..-5FD51-Z Y02 BKS E91) EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbuttons CES SSP 9 3SB3. ..-1KA20-Z Y02 BKS E2, E7, E91) 3SB3. ..-1LA20-Z Y02 1) Delivery of these BKS key-operated switches (locks for VW) without key. Ordering notes • For all special locks, an additional price applies. • The order code "Y01" or "Y02" must be quoted in accordance with the above table. Automated processing of the order with a defined delivery time can be guaranteed only for correctly submitted orders. • For applications in which access security is important and several lock numbers are used, we recommend the use of BKS or CES key-operated switches. • Special locks for VW (E1, E2, ...) will be delivered without keys, all others with 2 keys. 10/68 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 Illustrations are approximate © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Inscriptions Laser inscriptions ■ Overview Inscription of actuators and indicators Ordering notes Actuators and indicators of plastic as well as metal version can be optionally inscribed with a laser. When ordering, supplement the Order No. of the actuator or the indicator light with "–Z" and an order code: • Text line in upper/lower case, always upper case for beginning of line (e.g. "Lift off"): Y10 • Text in upper case (e.g. "LIFT OFF"): Y11 • Text in lower case (e.g. "lift off"): Y12 • Text in upper/lower case, all words begin with capital letters (e.g. "Lift Off"): Y15 • Symbol with number according to ISO 7000 or IEC 60417: Y13 • Any inscription or symbol according to order form supplement: Y19 Additional price per unit for Y10 to Y19 on request. When ordering, specify the required inscription in plain text in addition to the order number and order code. In the case of special inscriptions with words in languages other than German, give the exact spelling and specify the language (see ordering example 1). Pushbutton (metal) with laser inscription The actuators of the pushbuttons, illuminated pushbuttons, mushroom pushbuttons and illuminated mushroom pushbuttons can be inscribed as well as the lenses of the indicator lights. Selector switches can be inscribed only if they are made of plastic (only one text line on the front ring). In the case of multi-line inscriptions, the text must be assigned to the respective line, e.g. "Z1 = Lift, Z2 =Lower". For long words you can also specify the end-of-line division. Symbols can also be ordered with numbers according to ISO 7000 or IEC 60417 (see ordering example 2 and 3). For special symbols (order code Y19), a CAD drawing in DXF format can be submitted. Ordering example 1 A round pushbutton with the inscription "Reset" is required: 3SB30 00–0AA41–Z Y10 Z = Reset (English) A square pushbutton inscribed with symbol No. 5389 according to IEC 60417 is required: 3SB31 10–0AA31–Z Y13 Z = 5389 IEC Ordering example 3 A round pushbutton inscribed with symbol No. 1118 according to ISO 7000 is required: Pushbutton and selector switch (plastic) with laser inscription Version A letter height of 4 mm is used as standard for text inscriptions: 3SB30 00–0AA41–Z Y13 Z = 1118 ISO The typeface used is Arial. Other letter heights and typefaces are possible, but must be specified when ordering. For round buttons and lenses, the possible number of characters per line is: • 10 characters for one line of text • 8 characters for 2 lines of text • 6 characters for 3 lines of text, but 10 characters in the middle line On square buttons and lenses, 10 characters are possible per line. Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/69 10 Ordering example 2 © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Inscriptions Inscriptions by laser printer ■ Overview Label inscriptions Using the Label Designer software, which can be downloaded from the Internet, and the inscription labels for laser inscription you can create your own customized labels with a standard laser printer. The self-adhesive or snap-on labels can be stuck or snapped onto the corresponding label holders (see Name plates). Round labels are provided for inserting in illuminated pushbuttons and switches. The labels are suitable for printing with one to three lines of text or symbols. For applications with more exacting requirements we recommend factory-printed inscription labels and insert labels (laserprinted or engraved depending on the type). You can find the Label Designer software on the Internet at: www.siemens.com/sirius-label-designer ■ Selection and ordering data Version Color DT Order No. Insert labels For inserting in round illuminated pushbuttons and illuminated switches Milky A Inscription labels 12.5 mm x 27 mm For sticking onto label holder White Inscription labels 27 mm x 27 mm For sticking onto label holder Price per PU PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG 3SB3901-2AB 100 480 units 102 A 3SB3902-2AA 100 480 units 102 White A 3SB3903-2AA 100 480 units 102 Inscription labels 17.5 mm x 28 mm For snapping onto label holder White A 3SB3905-2AA 100 720 units 102 Inscription labels 22 mm x 22 mm For sticking onto enclosure White A 3SB3906-2AA 100 700 units 102 10 Labels for printing 10/70 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Inscriptions Insert labels ■ Overview Pushbuttons (clear) and illuminated pushbuttons with a flat button can be fitted with insert labels for identification purposes, but indicator lights cannot. These insert labels are made of clear, transparent plastic with black inscription; they can be fitted in any 90° angle. Inscriptions The inscriptions have upper case initial letters. Graphic symbols, including those not listed in the catalog, are according to ISO 7000 or IEC 60417 (see page 10/72). The insert labels without inscription are suitable for user marking with permanent pen. ■ Selection and ordering data PU (UNIT) = 100 (customized inscription: 1) PS* = 10 units (customized inscription: 1 unit) PG = 102 Inscription/Symbol Symbol No. DT Round range Order No. DT Square range Price per PU Order No. Price per PU Insert labels For self-inscription B 3SB1901-4AS B 3SB3940-4AA Ein On Aus Off B B B B 3SB1901-4AB 3SB1901-4EB 3SB1901-4AC 3SB1901-4EC B B B B 3SB3940-4AB 3SB3940-4EB 3SB3940-4AC 3SB3940-4EC Auf Up Ab Down B B B B 3SB1901-4AD 3SB1901-4ED 3SB1901-4AE 3SB1901-4EE B B B B 3SB3940-4AD 3SB3940-4ED 3SB3940-4AE 3SB3940-4EE Vor Forward Zurück Reverse B B B B 3SB1901-4AF 3SB1901-4EF 3SB1901-4AG 3SB1901-4EG B -3SB3940-4EF -3SB3940-4EG Rechts Right Links Left B C B C 3SB1901-4AH 3SB1901-4EH 3SB1901-4AJ 3SB1901-4EJ Auf Open Zu Close B B B B 3SB1901-4AD 3SB1901-4EP 3SB1901-4AL 3SB1901-4EQ B Schnell Fast Langsam Slow B B B B 3SB1901-4AM 3SB1901-4ER 3SB1901-4AN 3SB1901-4ES B Betrieb Running Störung Fault B B B B 3SB1901-4AP 3SB1901-4EV 3SB1901-4AQ 3SB1901-4EW Einrichten Reset B B 3SB1901-4AR 3SB1901-4EM B -3SB3940-4EM Test Start Halt Stop B B B B 3SB1901-4EN 3SB1901-4EK 3SB1901-4AK 3SB1901-4EL B B B -3SB3940-4EK 3SB3940-4AK 3SB3940-4EL Blank With inscription B ----- B B 10 B 3SB3940-4AD -3SB3940-4AL -3SB3940-4AM -3SB3940-4AN ---3SB3940-4AQ -- With graphic symbol O (Off) 5008 IEC B 3SB1901-4MB B 3SB3940-4MB I (On) 5007 IEC B 3SB1901-4MC B 3SB3940-4MC II (On) -- B 3SB1901-4MD B 3SB3940-4MD Electric motor 0011 ISO B 3SB1901-4PA Motion in direction of arrow 5022 IEC B 3SB1901-4NA B 3SB3940-4NA Increase, plus 5005 IEC B 3SB1901-4NG B 3SB3940-4NG Decrease, minus 5006 IEC B 3SB1901-4MC B 3SB3940-4MC -- With customized inscription 3SB1901-4AZ For inscriptions or symbols see "Options" 3SB3940-4AZ • Text line(s) or symbol with No. D K0Y, K1Y, K2Y, K3Y or K5Y B K0Y, K1Y, K2Y, K3Y or K5Y • Any inscription or symbol D K9Y B K9Y * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/71 © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Inscriptions Insert labels ■ Options Customized inscriptions Ordering notes The labels can be inscribed with text and symbols not listed in the ordering data. Append the following codes to the Order No.: • Text line(s) in upper/lower case, upper case always for beginning of line (e.g. "Lift off"): K0Y • Text line(s) in upper case (e.g. "LIFT OFF"): K1Y • Text line(s) in lower case (e.g. "lift off"): K2Y • Text line(s) in upper/lower case, all words begin with upper case letters (e.g. "Lift Off"): K5Y • Symbol with number according to ISO 7000 or IEC 60417: K3Y • Any inscription or symbol according to order form supplement: K9Y By default, a letter height of 4 mm (for a single line of text) or 3 mm (for 2 or 3 lines of text) is used for text inscriptions. The typeface used is Arial. Other letter heights and typefaces are possible, but must be specified when ordering. For round insert labels, the maximum possible number of characters per line is: • 10 characters for one line of text • 8 characters for 2 lines of text • 6 characters for 3 lines of text, but 10 characters in the middle line On square insert labels, 10 characters are possible per line. Examples for customized inscription When ordering, specify the required inscription in plain text in addition to the order number and order code. In the case of special inscriptions with words in languages other than German, give the exact spelling and specify the language. In the case of multi-line inscriptions, the text must be assigned to the respective line, e.g. "Z1 = Lift, Z2 =Lower". For long words you can also specify the end-of-line division (see ordering example 1). Lift Off Symbols can also be ordered with numbers according to ISO 7000 or IEC 60417 (see ordering example 2 and 3). Two-line inscription in upper/lower case lettering (K0Y) Ordering example 1 LIFT A label with 2 lines of text is required: Single-line inscription in upper case lettering (K1Y) lift off down 10 For special symbols (order code K9Y), a CAD drawing in DXF format can be submitted. 3SB19 01–4AZ K1Y Z1 = LIFT Z2 = LOWER Ordering example 2 A label inscribed with symbol No. 5011 according to IEC 60417 is required: Three-line inscription in lower case letters (K2Y) 3SB19 01–4AZ K3Y Z = 5011 IEC Ordering example 3 A label inscribed with symbol No. 1118 according to ISO 7000 is required: Symbol number 5011 according to IEC 60147 (K3Y) Any symbol according to order form supplement (K9Y) 10/72 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 3SB19 01–4AZ K3Y Z = 1118 ISO © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Inscriptions Name plates ■ Overview The name plates consist of a black plastic label holder and an inscription label (black with white print or silver-colored with black print) for sticking or snapping in place. They are not suitable for EMERGENCY-STOP pushbuttons. Note mounting dimensions! Inscriptions The inscriptions have upper case initial letters. The typeface is Arial. Graphic symbols, including those not listed in the tables, are according to ISO 7000 or IEC 60417 (see page 10/77). Self-adhesive labels There are 2 sizes available for the round and square ranges: • Label holders 30 mm × 45 mm × 7 mm with inscription label 12.5 mm × 27 mm. • Label holders 30 mm × 60 mm × 7 mm with inscription label 27 mm × 27 mm. Snap-on labels The following version is available for the round range: • Label holders 29.8 mm × 51 mm × 3 mm with inscription label 17.5 mm × 28 mm (inscription area: 17.5 mm × 27 mm). ■ Selection and ordering data PU (UNIT) = 100 (customized inscription: 1) PS* = 10 units (customized inscription: 1 unit) PG = 102 Inscriptions DT Black Order No. DT Silver-colored Price per PU Order No. Price per PU Inscription labels, self-adhesive, 12.5 mm × 27 mm For self-inscription } 3SB3902-1AA B 3SB1901-2AA Ein On Aus Off B B B B 3SB3902-1AB 3SB3902-1EB 3SB3902-1AC 3SB3902-1EC B B B B 3SB1901-2AB 3SB1901-2EB 3SB1901-2AC 3SB1901-2EC Auf Up Ab Down B B B B 3SB3902-1AD 3SB3902-1ED 3SB3902-1AE 3SB3902-1EE B B B B 3SB1901-2AD 3SB1901-2ED 3SB1901-2AE 3SB1901-2EE Vor Forward Zurück Reverse B B B B 3SB3902-1AF 3SB3902-1EF 3SB3902-1AG 3SB3902-1EG B 3SB1901-2AF -3SB1901-2AG -- Rechts Right Links Left B B B B 3SB3902-1AH 3SB3902-1EH 3SB3902-1AJ 3SB3902-1EJ B B B B 3SB1901-2AH 3SB1901-2EH 3SB1901-2AJ 3SB1901-2EJ Auf Open Zu Close B B B B 3SB3902-1AD 3SB3902-1EP 3SB3902-1AL 3SB3902-1EQ B B B B 3SB1901-2AD 3SB1901-2EP 3SB1901-2AL 3SB1901-2EQ ----- B B B B 3SB1901-2AM 3SB1901-2ER 3SB1901-2AN 3SB1901-2ES Blank Schnell Fast Langsam Slow B Halt Stop Start Test B B B B 3SB3902-1AK 3SB3902-1EK 3SB3902-1EL 3SB3902-1EN B B B B 3SB1901-2AK 3SB1901-2EK 3SB1901-2EL 3SB1901-2EN Betrieb Running Störung Fault B 3SB3902-1AP -3SB3902-1AQ 3SB3902-1EW B B B B 3SB1901-2AP 3SB1901-2EV 3SB1901-2AQ 3SB1901-2EW --- B B 3SB1901-2AR 3SB1901-2EM 3SB3902-1BC 3SB3902-1BA 3SB3902-1EU --- B B B B B 3SB1901-2BC 3SB1901-2BA 3SB1901-2EU 3SB1901-2BE 3SB1901-2ET B B Einrichten Reset Stop Start Hand Auto Man Auto Hand O Auto Man O Auto B B B 10 With inscription For label holders see page 10/76. * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/73 © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Inscriptions Name plates Inscriptions DT Black Order No. DT Silver-colored Price per PU Order No. Price per PU Inscription labels, self-adhesive, 12.5 mm × 27 mm With graphic symbol O I II III B B 3SB3902-1MB 3SB3902-1MC --- B B C B 3SB1901-2MB 3SB1901-2MC 3SB1901-2MD 3SB1901-2ME OI I O II 1 O 2 1 2 B B B B B B 3SB3902-1MF 3SB3902-1MG -3SB3902-1ML 3SB1901-2MF 3SB1901-2MG 3SB1901-2MK -- ↑ → B B 3SB3902-1NJ 3SB3902-1NA B B 3SB1901-2NA 3SB1901-2NJ With customized inscription 3SB3902-1XZ For inscriptions or symbols see "Options" 3SB1901-2XZ • Text line(s) C K0Y D K0Y • Text line(s) or symbol with No. B K1Y, K2Y, K3Y or K5Y D K1Y, K2Y, K3Y or K5Y • Any inscription or symbol B K9Y D K9Y Inscriptions DT Black Order No. DT Silver-colored Price per PU Order No. Price per PU Inscription labels, self-adhesive, 27 mm × 27 mm For self-inscription B 3SB3903-1AA Ein On Aus Off B B B B 3SB3903-1AB 3SB3903-1EB 3SB3903-1AC 3SB3903-1EC ----- Auf Ab B B 3SB3903-1AD 3SB3903-1AE --- Vor Zurück Rechts Links B B B B 3SB3903-1AF 3SB3903-1AG 3SB3903-1AH 3SB3903-1AJ ----- Auf Zu B B 3SB3903-1AD 3SB3903-1AL --- Halt Start B B 3SB3903-1AK 3SB3903-1EL --- Betrieb Störung B B 3SB3903-1AP 3SB3903-1AQ --- Stop Start Hand Auto B B 3SB3903-1BC 3SB3903-1BA --- O B 3SB3903-1MB -- OI B 3SB3903-1MF -- → B 3SB3903-1NA -- Blank B 3SB1906-2AA 10 With inscription With graphic symbol With customized inscription 3SB3903-1XZ For inscriptions or symbols see "Options" 3SB1906-2XZ • Text line(s) C K0Y D K0Y • Text line(s) or symbol with No. B K1Y, K2Y, K3Y or K5Y D K1Y, K2Y, K3Y or K5Y • Any inscription or symbol B K9Y D K9Y For label holders see page 10/76. 10/74 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 Illustrations are approximate © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Inscriptions Name plates Inscriptions DT Black Order No. DT Silver-colored Price per PU Order No. Price per PU Inscription labels, for snapping on, 17.5 mm × 28 mm For self-inscription B 3SB3905-1AA B 3SB1904-2AA Ein On Aus Off B B B B 3SB3905-1AB 3SB3905-1EB 3SB3905-1AC 3SB3905-1EC B B B B 3SB1904-2AB 3SB1904-2EB 3SB1904-2AC 3SB1904-2EC Auf Up Ab Down B B B B 3SB3905-1AD 3SB3905-1ED 3SB3905-1AE 3SB3905-1EE B 3SB1904-2AD -3SB1904-2AE -- Vor Forward Zurück Reverse B B B B 3SB3905-1AF 3SB3905-1EF 3SB3905-1AG 3SB3905-1EG B Rechts Right Links B B 3SB3905-1AH 3SB3905-1EH -- B Auf Open Zu Close B B B B 3SB3905-1AD 3SB3905-1EP 3SB3905-1AL 3SB3905-1EQ B Halt Stop Start Test B B B 3SB3905-1AK 3SB3905-1EK 3SB3905-1EL -- B B B B 3SB1904-2AK 3SB1904-2EK 3SB1904-2EL 3SB1904-2EN Betrieb Running Störung Fault B B B B 3SB3905-1AP 3SB3905-1EV 3SB3905-1AQ 3SB3905-1EW B B B 3SB1904-2AP -3SB1904-2AQ 3SB1904-2EW --- B B 3SB1904-2AR 3SB1904-2EM B B B 3SB3905-1BC 3SB3905-1BA 3SB3905-1EU -- B B C B 3SB1904-2BC 3SB1904-2BA 3SB1904-2EU 3SB1904-2ET O I B B 3SB3905-1MB 3SB3905-1MC B B 3SB1904-2MB 3SB1904-2MC OI I O II 1 O 2 B 3SB3905-1MF --- B B B 3SB1904-2MF 3SB1904-2MG 3SB1904-2MK → ↑ B B 3SB3905-1NA 3SB3905-1NJ B B 3SB1904-2NA 3SB1904-2NJ Blank With inscription Einrichten Reset Stop Start Hand Auto Man Auto Man O Auto B B B B B 3SB1904-2AF -3SB1904-2AG 3SB1904-2EG 3SB1904-2AH -3SB1904-2AJ 3SB1904-2AD -3SB1904-2AL -- 10 With graphic symbol With customized inscription 3SB3905-1XZ For inscriptions or symbols see "Options" 3SB1904-2XZ • Text line(s) C K0Y D K0Y • Text line(s) or symbol with No. B K1Y, K2Y, K3Y or K5Y D K1Y, K2Y, K3Y or K5Y • Any inscription or symbol B K9Y D K9Y For label holders see page 10/76. Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/75 © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Inscriptions Name plates Version DT Black Order No. PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG Price per PU Label holders for inscription labels 12.5 mm × 27 mm For round range, flat B 3SB3922-0AV For potentiometer drives 3SB10 00-7CH071) B 3SB3922-0AS 1 1 unit 102 For square range, flat B 3SB3942-0AX 100 5 units 102 For round range, flat B 3SB3923-0AV 100 10 units 102 For round range, raised C 3SB3923-0AX 1 10 units 102 For potentiometer drives, flat B 3SB3923-0AS 1 1 unit 102 For square range, flat B 3SB3943-0AX 100 1 unit 102 } 3SB3925-0AV 100 10 units 102 100 10 units 102 3SB39 22-0AV Label holders for inscription labels 27 mm × 27 mm 3SB39 23-0AV Label holders for inscription labels 17.5 mm × 28 mm For round design 3SB39 25-0AV This label holder can also be used for pushbuttons with dust covers if the front panel thickness of 3 mm is not exceeded. 10 1) 10/76 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Inscriptions Name plates ■ Options Customized inscriptions Ordering notes The labels can be inscribed with text and symbols not listed in the ordering data. Append the following codes to the Order No.: • Text line(s) in upper/lower case, upper case always for beginning of line (e.g. "Lift off"): K0Y • Text line(s) in upper case (e.g. "LIFT OFF"): K1Y • Text line(s) in lower case (e.g. "lift off"): K2Y • Text line(s) in upper/lower case, all words begin with upper case letters (e.g. "Lift Off"): K5Y • Symbol with number according to ISO 7000 or IEC 60417: K3Y • Any inscription or symbol according to order form supplement: K9Y The following letter heights are used as standard for text inscriptions: • Label size 12.5 mm × 27 mm: maximum 3 lines with letter height 4 mm (1-line), 3.5 mm (2-line) or 2.5 mm (3-line) • Label size 27 mm × 27 mm: maximum 5 lines with letter height 4 mm (1- to 5-line) • Label size 17.5 mm × 28 mm: maximum 3 lines with letter height 4 mm (1- and 2-line) or 3 mm (3-line) Up to 11 characters per line are possible. The typeface used is Arial. Other letter heights and typefaces are possible, but must be specified when ordering. Examples for customized inscription Two-line inscription in upper/lower case lettering (K0Y) When ordering, specify the required inscription in plain text in addition to the order number and order code. In the case of special inscriptions with words in languages other than German, give the exact spelling and specify the language. In the case of multi-line inscriptions, the text must be assigned to the respective line, e.g. "Z1 = Lift, Z2 =Lower". For long words you can also specify the end-of-line division (see ordering example 1). Symbols can also be ordered with numbers according to ISO 7000 or IEC 60417 (see ordering example 2 and 3). For special symbols (order code K9Y), a CAD drawing in DXF format can be submitted. Single-line inscription in upper case lettering (K1Y) Ordering example 1 A label with 2 lines of text is required: Three-line inscription in lower case letters (K2Y) 3SB39 02–1XZ K1Y Z1 = LIFT Z2 = LOWER Ordering example 2 Symbol number 5011 according to IEC 60417 (K3Y) 10 A label inscribed with symbol No. 5011 according to IEC 60417 is required: 3SB39 02–1XZ K3Y Z = 5011 IEC Ordering example 3 Any symbol according to order form supplement (K9Y) A label inscribed with symbol No. 1118 according to ISO 7000 is required: 3SB39 02–1XZ K3Y Z = 1118 ISO Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/77 © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Accessories and Spare Parts Buttons and lenses ■ Selection and ordering data Version Color DT Order No. Buttons, flat For round illuminated pushbuttons and illuminated switches, plastic version Red Yellow Green Blue White Clear B B B B B B 3SB39 30-0CA6 Buttons, flat For round pushbuttons and switches, metal version Black Red Yellow Green Blue White Clear 3SB39 30-0EA3 Buttons, raised For round illuminated pushbuttons and illuminated switches, plastic version Price per PU PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG 3SB3930-0CA2 3SB3930-0CA3 3SB3930-0CA4 3SB3930-0CA5 3SB3930-0CA6 3SB3930-0CA7 100 100 100 100 100 100 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 102 102 102 102 102 102 B B B B B B B 3SB3930-0EA1 3SB3930-0EA2 3SB3930-0EA3 3SB3930-0EA4 3SB3930-0EA5 3SB3930-0EA6 3SB3930-0EA7 100 100 100 100 100 100 100 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 102 102 102 102 102 102 102 Red Green Clear B B B 3SB3930-0DA2 3SB3930-0DA4 3SB3930-0DA7 1 10 units 1 10 units 1 10 units 102 102 102 Buttons, raised For round pushbuttons and switches, metal version Black Red Yellow Green Blue White Clear D C C C C C C 3SB3930-0FA1 3SB3930-0FA2 3SB3930-0FA3 3SB3930-0FA4 3SB3930-0FA5 3SB3930-0FA6 3SB3930-0FA7 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 102 102 102 102 102 102 102 Buttons, flat For round illuminated pushbuttons and illuminated switches, metal version Amber Red Yellow Green Blue White Clear B B B B B B B 3SB3930-0GA0 3SB3930-0GA2 3SB3930-0GA3 3SB3930-0GA4 3SB3930-0GA5 3SB3930-0GA6 3SB3930-0GA7 100 100 100 100 100 100 100 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 102 102 102 102 102 102 102 Buttons, flat, solvent-resistant2), For round illuminated pushbuttons and switches, metal version Red Yellow Green Blue White Clear B B B B B B 3SB3930-0GA20-0PA0 3SB3930-0GA30-0PA0 3SB3930-0GA40-0PA0 3SB3930-0GA50-0PA0 3SB3930-0GA60-0PA0 3SB3930-0GA70-0PA0 100 100 100 100 100 100 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 102 102 102 102 102 102 Buttons, raised For round illuminated pushbuttons and illuminated switches, metal version Amber Red Yellow Green Blue White Clear C C C C C C C 3SB3930-0HA0 3SB3930-0HA2 3SB3930-0HA3 3SB3930-0HA4 3SB3930-0HA5 3SB3930-0HA6 3SB3930-0HA7 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 102 102 102 102 102 102 102 Lenses, smooth For round indicator lights, plastic and metal version Amber Red Yellow Green Blue White Clear C B B B B B B 3SB3930-6BA0 3SB3930-6BA2 3SB3930-6BA3 3SB3930-6BA4 3SB3930-6BA5 3SB3930-6BA6 3SB3930-6BA7 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 102 102 102 102 102 102 102 Lenses with concentric rings For round indicator lights, plastic and metal version Amber Red Yellow Green Blue White Clear B B B B B B B 3SB3930-6CA0 3SB3930-6CA2 3SB3930-6CA3 3SB3930-6CA4 3SB3930-6CA5 3SB3930-6CA6 3SB3930-6CA7 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 102 102 102 102 102 102 102 Buttons, flat For square illuminated pushbuttons and illuminated switches, plastic version Red Yellow Green Blue White Clear B B B B B B 3SB3950-0CA2 3SB3950-0CA3 3SB3950-0CA4 3SB3950-0CA5 3SB3950-0CA6 3SB3950-0CA7 100 100 100 100 100 100 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 102 102 102 102 102 102 Lenses, smooth For square indicator lights, plastic version Red Yellow Green Blue White Clear B B B B B B 3SB3950-6AA2 3SB3950-6AA3 3SB3950-6AA4 3SB3950-6AA5 3SB3950-6AA6 3SB3950-6AA7 1 1 1 1 1 1 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 102 102 102 102 102 102 Buttons and lenses for round version1) 3SB39 30-0DA4 3SB39 30-0FA4 10 3SB39 30-0GA3 3SB39 30-0HA4 3SB39 30-6BA3 3SB39 30-6CA3 Buttons and lenses for square version 3SB39 50-0CA6 3SB39 50-6AA2 1) In scope of supply of pushbuttons or indicator lights. 2) Not suitable for laser inscription. 10/78 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Accessories and Spare Parts Lamps, acoustic signal transformers and keys ■ Selection and ordering data Version Price per PU PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG 24 AC/DC Clear A 3SB1902-0AY 1 10 units 102 Incandescent lamps 2 W Length up to 28 mm, max. bulb diameter 10 mm 6 AC/DC 12 AC/DC 24 AC/DC 30 AC/DC 48 AC/DC 60 AC/DC Clear A A A B B A 3SX1342 3SX1343 3SX1344 3SB1902-2AF 3SB1902-1AP 3SR9424 1 1 1 1 1 1 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 102 102 102 102 102 102 Incandescent lamps 2.6 W Length 28 mm, bulb diameter 10 mm 110 ... 130 AC/DC2) Clear } 3SX1731 1 10 units 102 Multi-incandescent lamps 1.2 W Endurance 25 000 h, high resistance to vibration 24 AC/DC B 3SB1902-2BU 1 10 units 102 LED lamps, super-bright Length up to 28 mm, max. bulb diameter 10 mm, max. operational current 15 mA 24 AC/DC Red Yellow Green Blue White } B } B } 3SB3901-1CA 3SB3901-1BA 3SB3901-1DA 3SB3901-1PA 3SB3901-1QA 1 1 1 1 1 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 102 102 102 102 102 48 AC/DC Red Yellow Green Blue White B B B B B 3SB3901-1CC 3SB3901-1BC 3SB3901-1DC 3SB3901-1PC 3SB3901-1QC 1 1 1 1 1 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 102 102 102 102 102 130 AC, 70 ... 90 DC, if X1 at "+" Red Yellow Green Blue White B B B B B 3SB3901-1CD 3SB3901-1BD 3SB3901-1DD 3SB3901-1PD 3SB3901-1QD 1 1 1 1 1 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 102 102 102 102 102 230 AC, 110 ... 160 DC, if X1 at "+" Red Yellow Green Blue White B B B B B 3SB3901-1CF 3SB3901-1BF 3SB3901-1DF 3SB3901-1PF 3SB3901-1QF 1 1 1 1 1 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 102 102 102 102 102 230 AC/DC Red Yellow Green Blue White B B B B B 3SB3901-1CG 3SB3901-1BG 3SB3901-1DG 3SB3901-1PG 3SB3901-1QG 1 1 1 1 1 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 102 102 102 102 102 LED lamps Length up to 28 mm, max. bulb diameter 10 mm, max. operational current 15 mA 22 ... 32 DC Red Yellow Green D D D 3SB1902-4AJ 3SB1902-4BJ 3SB1902-4CJ 1 10 units 1 10 units 1 10 units 102 102 102 LED lamps, flashing (1.4 Hz) Length up to 28 mm, bulb diameter 10 mm, operational current 24 ... 29 mA 24 DC Red Yellow Green B C C 3SB1902-4LC 3SB1902-4MC 3SB1902-4NC 1 10 units 1 10 units 1 10 units 102 102 102 Clear Clear Green A A C 3SX1703 3SX1701 3SX1702 1 1 1 10 units 10 units 10 units 102 102 102 } 3SB1902-2AD 1 1 unit 102 Glow lamps3) 110 AC Length 28 mm, bulb diameter 10 mm, 220 AC operational current approx. 1.8 mA 220 AC 3SX1 703 Lamp extractors For lamps with BA 9s base 3SB19 02-2AD 1) Essential accessories when using lampholders with BA 9s base and delivery without lamp. 2) Also for 230 V when used with a 3SB34 00-1C voltage reducer. 3) Due to the inherent orange color of glow lamps and their lower luminance level compared to incandescent lamps, it is recommended that they should only be used with clear or red screw lenses and in areas where ambient light levels are not very high. * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/79 10 Incandescent lamps 1.2 W Length up to 28 mm, max. bulb diameter 10 mm 3SB39 01-1PA 3SB19 02-4MC DT Order No. V Lamps, BA 9s bases1) 3SB19 02-0AY Rated voltage Color © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Accessories and Spare Parts Lamps, acoustic signal transformers and keys Version Rated voltage Color DT Order No. Price per PU PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG V Lamps, Wedge bases1) Incandescent lamps Wedge base W2 × 4.6 d, 1.0 W 6 AC/DC 12 AC/DC 24 AC/DC 30 AC/DC 48 AC/DC 60 AC/DC Clear C B } A B B 3SB2908-1AA 3SB2908-1AB 3SB2908-1AC 3SB2908-1AD 3SB2908-1AE 3SB2908-1AF 100 100 100 100 1 1 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 102 102 102 102 102 102 LED lamps, super-bright Wedge base W2 × 4.6 d, operational current 10 mA 24 AC/DC Red Yellow Green White Blue B B B B B 3SB3901-1SB 3SB3901-1RB 3SB3901-1TB 3SB3901-1UB 3SB2908-1BD 1 1 1 1 1 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 102 102 102 102 102 28 AC/DC Red Yellow Green White Blue B B B B D 3SB3901-1SE 3SB3901-1RE 3SB3901-1TE 3SB3901-1UE 3SB3901-1VE 1 1 1 1 1 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 10 units 102 102 102 102 102 Lamp extractors For lamps with bases W2 × 4.6 d } 3SB2908-2AB 1 1 unit 102 Lamp adapters For fitting a lamp with a wedge base socket into a BA 9s lampholder C 3SB1902-1AU 1 1 unit 102 B 3SB1902-2BN 1 1 unit 102 PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG 3SB29 08-1AE 3SB39 01-1SB 3SB39 01-1VE 3SB29 08-2AB 3SB19 02-1AU Acoustic signal transformers, BA 9s base Acoustic signal transformers For acoustic signaling devices2) operational current 25 mA, 0.6 W, sound pressure 80 dB/10 cm 24 ... 28 DC 3SB19 02-2BN 1) Can be used with lamp adapters in lampholders with BA 9s base. 2) For increased protection, the IP65 acoustic signaling device (complete unit) can be used. 10 Version Lock Color Manufacturer Lock No. DT Order No. Price per PU Keys for actuators1)2) 3SY1 054 Ronis SB 30 B 3SB3910-4A 1 1 unit 102 BKS S1 A 3SY1066 1 1 unit 102 CES LSG 1 SSG 10 SSP 9 B B A 3SB1910-2F 3SY1054 3SY1052 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 O.M.R. 73038 73037 73034 73033 C B B D 3SB1910-2L 3SB1910-2M 3SB1910-2N 3SB1910-2P 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 1) Included in scope of supply of the key-operated switches and the EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbuttons with lock. 2) Also available with special lock. Supplement Order No. with "-Z" and quote the required lock in plain text. Additional price on request. This does not include locks for VW and main and general locking systems. 10/80 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 Light blue Red Black Yellow * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Accessories and Spare Parts Protective covers ■ Selection and ordering data Version Use Color DT Order No. Price per PU PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG Protective caps1), degree of protection IP67 Material: elastolan Protective caps For round version Flat button (plastic) Clear B 3SB3921-0AJ 1 1 unit 102 Flat button (metal), raised button (plastic) Clear B 3SB3921-0AM 1 1 unit 102 • PVC Raised button (metal) Clear C 3SB1902-2AN 1 1 unit 102 Protective caps For square version Flat button (plastic) Clear B 3SB3941-0AJ 1 1 unit 102 Flat button (plastic) Clear B 3SB3921-0AH 1 1 unit 102 Flat button (metal), raised button (plastic) Clear B 3SB1902-0AK 1 1 unit 102 Raised button (metal) Clear B 3SB1902-0AN 1 1 unit 102 Protective caps For round version Selector switch (plastic and metal, normal handle) Clear B 3SB3921-0BA 1 1 unit 102 Protective caps For round version Mushroom push-pull button, Ø 40 mm (plastic and metal) Clear B 3SB1902-2BH 1 1 unit 102 EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom Clear pushbutton, Ø 40 mm (plastic and metal) B 3SB3921-0BU 1 1 unit 102 Flat button (plastic) B 3SB3941-0AH 1 1 unit 102 3SB39 21-0AJ 3SB39 41-0AJ Material: silicone Protective caps For round version 3SB39 21-0AH 3SB19 02-0AK 10 3SB19 02-0AN 3SB39 21-0BA 3SB19 02-2BH 3SB39 21-0BU Protective caps For square version Clear 3SB39 41-0AH 1) Not for mounting in 3SB38 enclosure with 3SB34 20 or 3SB34 23 contact blocks and lampholders for floor mounting. Not to be used with label holder. * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/81 © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Accessories and Spare Parts Protective covers Version Use Color DT Order No. Price per PU PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG Other protective caps1) Flat button (plastic) Black B 3SB1902-0AL 1 1 unit 102 Flat button (metal), raised button (plastic) Clear B 3SB1902-2AR 1 1 unit 102 BKS, CES, O.M.R. key-operated switch Clear B 3SB3921-0BT 1 1 unit 102 Protective collars for EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom EMERGENCY-STOP2) pushbutton For round version without lock Yellow } 3SB3921-0AK 1 1 unit 102 Gray C 3SB3921-0AP 1 1 unit 102 EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbutton with key-operated switch Yellow B 3SB3921-0AX 1 1 unit 102 Protective collars for 3SB3...-1AA20 EMERGENCYEMERGENCY-STOP STOP mushroom pushbutton for 5 padlocks2) For round version Yellow } 3SB3921-0CG 1 1 unit 102 Sun collars For round version Black B 3SB3921-0AS 1 1 unit 102 Sealable caps For round version 3SB19 02-0AL 3SB19 02-2AR Dust covers For use in dusty environments 3SB39 21-0BT Protective collars for front plates 3SB39 21-0AX 10 3SB39 21-0CG Illuminated pushbuttons 3SB39 21-0AS Blanking plugs for spare command points for front plates Blanking plugs For round version Plastic version Black } 3SB3921-0AA 1 10 units 102 Blanking plugs For square version Plastic version Black B 3SB3941-0AA 1 1 unit 102 Blanking plugs (plastic) for round version Metal version Aluminized B 3SB1902-0AQ 1 10 units 102 3SB39 21-0AA 3SB39 41-0AA 3SB19 02-0AQ 1) Unsuitable for mounting in 3SB38 enclosures. Not to be used with label holder. 2) The protective collar must only be used to protect against inadvertent actuating and must be fitted to allow unimpeded actuation of the EMERGENCYSTOP mushroom pushbutton. 10/82 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Accessories and Spare Parts Miscellaneous accessories ■ Selection and ordering data Version Use Inscriptions DT Order No. B Price per PU PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG 3SB3921-0DY 1 1 unit 102 Yellow name plates for EMERGENCY-STOP For use on front plates Name plates, round Self-adhesive, external diameter 60 mm, internal diameter 23 mm EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbutton (round version) Blank Name plates, round Self-adhesive, external diameter 80 mm, internal diameter 23 mm EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbutton (round version) Blank B 3SB3921-0AB 1 1 unit 102 4 languages, de1), en, it, es B 3SB3921-0BW 1 1 unit 102 NOT-HALT B 3SB3921-0AC 1 1 unit 102 NOT-AUS B 3SB3921-0CK 1 1 unit 102 EMERGENCY STOP B 3SB3921-0AD 1 1 unit 102 ARRET D’URGENCE B 3SB3921-0AG 1 1 unit 102 EMERGENZA B 3SB3921-0AN 1 1 unit 102 Blank B 3SB3941-0AB 1 1 unit 102 NOT-HALT B 3SB3941-0AC 1 1 unit 102 NOT-AUS B 3SB3941-0BX 1 1 unit 102 EMERGENCY STOP B 3SB3941-0AD 1 1 unit 102 3SB39 21-0AC 3SB39 21-0DA Name plates, round 1 mm thick, external diameter 75 mm, internal diameter 22.5 mm EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbutton (round version) Blank B 3SB1902-2BA 1 1 unit 102 NOT-HALT B 3SB1902-2BB 1 1 unit 102 NOT-AUS B 3SB3921-0CH 1 1 unit 102 Name plates, round Self-adhesive, external diameter 60 mm, internal diameter 23 mm2) EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbutton (round version) Blank B 3SB3921-0DA 1 1 unit 102 NOT-HALT B 3SB3921-0DK 1 1 unit 102 NOT-AUS B 3SB3921-0DC 1 1 unit 102 EMERGENCY STOP B 3SB3921-0DD 1 1 unit 102 Illuminated, suitable as signaling device for EMERGENCY-STOP, with plug-in connection for 24 V AC/DC3) 10 3SB39 21-0BW Name plates, round EMERGENCY-STOP Self-adhesive, mushroom pushbuttons external diameter (square version) 80 mm, cutout 26 mm × 26 mm Inscription labels Inscription labels For supporting dust resistance Contact blocks B 3SB3901-0CH 100 10 units 102 Unit labeling plates Contact blocks B 3TX4210-0H 100 100 units 101 3SB39 01-0CH 3TX4 210-0H 1) With German inscription "NOT-HALT". 2) For front panel thickness of max. 4 mm. 3) The illuminated label can also be operated through the AS-Interface F adapter (see page 10/68). * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/83 © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Accessories and Spare Parts Miscellaneous accessories Version Use DT Order No. Pushbuttons, push-pull buttons, mushroom pushbuttons with front plate mounting } Price per PU PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG 3SB3901-0AB 100 20 units 102 Holders with pressure plate Selector switches, key-oper- } For actuating the central contact ated switches and twin pushblock of 3 contact blocks buttons with front plate mounting 3SB3901-0AC 100 10 units 102 Pressure plates Selector switches and keyFor actuating the central contact operated switches for use on block of 3 contact blocks PCBs or with floor mounting B 3SB3901-0AW 100 10 units 102 } 3SB3931-0AA 1 10 units 102 Holders For plastic version, square B 3SB3951-0AA 1 1 unit 102 Holders For metal version, round } 3SB3931-0AC 1 10 units 102 Grounding screws For grounding metal actuators for fitting in front plates made of non-conducting materials B 3SB3921-0BD 100 50 units 102 Holders and pressure plates Holders For snapping on 3 blocks1) 3SB39 01-0AB 3SB39 01-0AC 3SB39 01-0AW Holders for commanding and signaling elements2) Holders For plastic version, round As-supplied state for front panel thickness 1 ... 4 mm 3SB39 31-0AA 10 3SB39 51-0AA 3SB39 31-0AC 3SB39 21-0BD 1) The holder for illuminated commanding devices is included in the scope of supply. 2) The matching holder for actuators and indicators is included in the scope of supply (exception: Order with order code "B01"). 10/84 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Accessories and Spare Parts Miscellaneous accessories Version Use Color DT Order No. Price per PU PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG Tools Blanking tools 26 mm × 26 mm, for square version B 3SB3941-0AF 1 1 unit 102 Hole drilling templates For 30 mm × 30 mm grid, horizontal, for round and square versions C 3SB1902-2BG 1 1 unit 102 Mounting tools For buttons and lenses, metal version B 3SB3921-0BC 1 1 unit 102 Mounting tools For potentiometer drives and for pushbuttons with extended stroke C 3SX1707 1 1 unit 102 Dismantling tools Blocks with For contact blocks and lampholders screw terminals B 3SB3901-0CB 1 1 unit 102 Dismantling tools With springFor contact blocks and lampholders type terminals C 3SB3901-0CG 1 1 unit 102 C 3SB3921-0AU 1 1 unit 102 1 1 unit 102 100 10 units 102 3SB39 41-0AF 3SB19 02-2BG 3SB39 21-0BC 3SX1 707 Various accessories Single frames For square design of the round version Black 3SB39 21-0AU Adapter parts Adapters for 30.5 mm mounting hole, comprising a metal disk with an adhesive layer on one side, degree of protection IP65 As thrust ring for a thin molded-plastic front plate B 3SB3921-0AE Printed circuit board holders For mounting the command devices on the printed circuit board (screw is included in the scope of supply) Contact blocks and lampholders for solder connection B 3SB3901-0AA Extension plungers For compensation of the distance between a pushbutton and the unlatching button of an overload relay Pushbuttons with extended stroke A 3SX1335 3SB39 21-0AE 3SB39 01-0AA 1 1 unit 102 3SX1 335 * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/85 10 3SB39 01-0CB © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Enclosures General data ■ Overview For AS-Interface enclosures see page 10/96. Enclosures with standard fittings I H G E B C2 NSD0_00049b C1 A Enclosures with standard and customized equipment Enclosed pushbuttons and indicator lights are used as hand operated control devices for separately allocated control units and cabinets. F D Enclosures with handle are available for suspension (e.g. for crane control units). A B C1 C2 D E F G H I The enclosed pushbuttons and indicator lights are available with conventional controls as well as for connection to the AS-Interface bus system. The following versions are available: • Enclosure with standard fittings with 1 to 3 command points • Enclosure with customized equipment with 1 to 6 command points • Empty enclosures (individual parts must be ordered separately). Standards Customer-specific enclosures 10 Top part of enclosure Inscription labels Pushbutton Indicator light Holder Contact designations Contact blocks, lampholders for floor mounting Bottom part of enclosure Identification letters for the command points Identification number IEC 60947-5-1, EN 60947-5-1 On request enclosures with more than 6 command points can also be supplied with AS-Interface connection. Use the configurator for selection. ■ Application The devices are climate-proof (KTW 24) according to EN ISO 6270-2 and suitable for stationary use (weatherprotected) and for use in marine applications. ■ Technical specifications Type 3SB38 0.-0, 3SB38 0.-1 3SB38 0.-2, 3SB38 0.-3 Enclosures Enclosure material Plastic Metal Actuators and indicators Plastic, round Metal, round Degree of protection acc. to IEC 60529 IP65 IP67 and NEMA Type 4 Climatic withstand capability acc. to EN ISO 6270-2 KTW 24 Shock resistance acc. to IEC 60068-2-27 for half-sine shock type, 11 ms shock duration • Devices without incandescent lamp ≤ 50 g • Devices with incandescent lamp ≤ 30 g Vibration resistance acc. to IEC 60068-2-6 • Acceleration at frequency 20 ... 200 Hz 10/86 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 5g © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Enclosures Enclosures with standard fittings ■ Overview Enclosures with standard fittings are available with: • 1 to 3 command points • Operational voltage up to 400 V • Vertical mounting type • Plastic enclosures are equipped with plastic actuators and indicators, metal enclosures are equipped with metal actuators and indicators • Contact blocks and lampholders for floor mounting (are snapped into the enclosure base). Screw terminals (box terminals) as standard; some versions also with spring-type terminals (Order No. ends with -0CC0). The actuators/indicators are fixed with an enclosure nut. If required it can be disassembled with a 27 mm socket wrench or with a 3SX17 07 ring nut wrench. Color of enclosure cover: • Gray, RAL 7035, or • Yellow, RAL 1004 Color of enclosure base: • Black, RAL 9005 ■ Selection and ordering data Equipment Contact block function Number of DT Screw terminals command points Order No. PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG Price per PU Plastic enclosures with standard fittings Cable entry top and bottom each 1 x M20 A = Pushbutton green, label "I" 1 NO 1 B 3SB3801-0DA3 1 1 unit 102 A = Pushbutton red, label "O" 1 NC 1 B 3SB3801-0DB3 1 1 unit 102 A = Pushbutton white, label "I" 1 NO 1 B 3SB3801-0DD3 1 1 unit 102 A = Pushbutton black, label "O" 1 NC 1 B 3SB3801-0DE3 1 1 unit 102 3SB38 01-0DA3 3SB38 01-0.F3 1 NC 2) 1 B 3SB3801-0DG3 1 1 unit 102 2 NC 2) 1 B 3SB3801-0EG3 1 1 unit 102 • With yellow top part, with protective collar1) 1 NC 2) 1 B 3SB3801-0DF3 1 1 unit 102 2 NC 2) 1 B 3SB3801-0EF3 1 1 unit 102 B = Pushbutton green, label "I" A = Pushbutton red, label "O" 1 NO, 1 NC 2 B 3SB3802-0DA3 1 1 unit 102 B = Pushbutton white, label "I" A = Pushbutton black, label "O" 1 NO, 1 NC 2 B 3SB3802-0DB3 1 1 unit 102 C = Indicator light clear, label without inscription, B = Pushbutton green, label "I", A = Pushbutton red, label "O" BA 9s3), 3 B 3SB3803-0DA3 1 1 unit 102 C = Pushbutton black, label "II" B = Pushbutton black, label "I", A = Pushbutton red, label "O" 1 NO, 1 NO, 1 NC 3 C 3SB3803-0DB3 1 1 unit 102 C = Indicator light clear, label without inscription, B = Pushbutton white, label "I", A = Pushbutton black, label "O" BA 9s3), 3 C 3SB3803-0DC3 1 1 unit 102 • With yellow top part, without protective collar 3SB38 02-0DA3 1 NO, 1 NC 1 NO, 1 NC 3SB38 03-0DA3 1) The protective collar must only be used to protect against inadvertent actuating and must be fitted to allow unimpeded access to the EMERGENCYSTOP mushroom pushbutton. 2) Positive opening according to IEC 60947-5-1, Appendix K. 3) Only lampholder; order lamp separately. * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/87 10 A = EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbuttons, Ø 40 mm, with positive latching according to ISO 13850 and rotate-to-unlatch mechanism © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Enclosures Enclosures with standard fittings Equipment Number of DT Screw terminals command points Spring-type terminals3) Contact block function Order No. PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG Price per PU Metal enclosures with standard fittings Cable entry top and bottom each 1 x M20 A = Pushbutton green, label "I" 1 NO 1 B 3SB3801-2DA3 1 1 unit 102 A = Pushbutton red, label "O" 1 NC 1 B 3SB3801-2DB3 1 1 unit 102 A = Pushbutton white, label "I" 1 NO 1 B 3SB3801-2DD3 1 1 unit 102 A = Pushbutton black, label "O" 1 NC 1 B 3SB3801-2DE3 1 1 unit 102 3SB38 01-2DB3 A = EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbuttons, Ø 40 mm, with positive latching according to ISO 13850 and rotate-to-unlatch mechanism 3SB38 01-2.F3 • With yellow top part, without protective collar - With M12 socket • With yellow top part, with protective collar1) 1 NC 2) 1 B 3SB3801-2DG3 1 1 unit 102 2 NC 2) 1 B 3SB3801-2EG3 1 1 unit 102 2 NC 2)3) 1 C 3SB3801-2EG10-0CC0 1 1 unit 102 1 NC 2) 1 B 3SB3801-2DF3 1 1 unit 102 2 NC 2) 1 B 3SB3801-2EF3 1 1 unit 102 2 NC 2) 1 B 3SB3801-2EA30 1 1 unit 102 2 NC 2)3) 1 B 3SB3801-2EA30-0CC0 1 1 unit 102 A = EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbuttons, Ø 60 mm, with positive latching according to ISO 13850 and rotate-to-unlatch mechanism 3SB38 01-2EB30 • With yellow top part, with protective collar for 5 padlocks A = mushroom pushbutton, Ø 60 mm, black, with positive latching and rotate-tounlatch mechanism 10 3SB38 02-2DA3 3SB38 03-2DA3 • With gray top part, with protective collar for 5 padlocks 2 NC3) 1 B 3SB3801-2EB30-0CC0 1 1 unit 102 B = Pushbutton green, label "I" A = Pushbutton red, label "O" 1 NO, 1 NC 2 B 3SB3802-2DA3 1 1 unit 102 B = Pushbutton white, label "I" A = Pushbutton black, label "O" 1 NO, 1 NC 2 B 3SB3802-2DB3 1 1 unit 102 C = Indicator light clear, label without inscription, B = Pushbutton green, label "I", A = Pushbutton red, label "O" BA 9s4), 3 B 3SB3803-2DA3 1 1 unit 102 1 NO, 1 NC C = Pushbutton black, label "II" B = Pushbutton black, label "I", A = Pushbutton red, label "O" 1 NO, 1 NO, 1 NC 3 B 3SB3803-2DB3 1 1 unit 102 C = Indicator light clear, label without inscription, B = Pushbutton white, label "I", A = Pushbutton black, label "O" BA 9s4), 3 B 3SB3803-2DC3 1 1 unit 102 1 NO, 1 NC 3SB38 03-2DB3 1) The protective collar must only be used to protect against inadvertent actuating and must be fitted to allow unimpeded access to the EMERGENCYSTOP mushroom pushbutton. 2) Positive opening according to IEC 60947-5-1, Appendix K. -0CC0: Contact blocks with spring-type terminals. 4) Only lampholder; order lamp separately. 3) 10/88 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Enclosures Empty enclosures ■ Selection and ordering data Version Number of DT Order No. command points Price per PU PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG Empty enclosures, plastic Cable entry top and bottom each 1 x M20 for 1 to 3 command points, each 1 x M25 for 4 and 6 command points 1 2 3 4 6 B B B B B 3SB3801-0AA3 3SB3802-0AA3 3SB3803-0AA3 3SB3804-0AA3 3SB3806-0AA3 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 • With yellow top part, without protective collar 1 B 3SB3801-0AB3 1 1 unit 102 • With yellow top part, with protective collar1) 1 B 3SB3801-0AD3 1 1 unit 102 1 2 3 4 6 B B B B B 3SB3801-2AA3 3SB3802-2AA3 3SB3803-2AA3 3SB3804-2AA3 3SB3806-2AA3 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 • With yellow top part, without protective collar 1 B 3SB3801-2AB3 1 1 unit 102 • With yellow top part, with protective collar1) 1 B 3SB3801-2AD3 1 1 unit 102 • With gray top part, with protective collar 1 B 3SB3801-2AE3 1 1 unit 102 • With yellow top part, 1 with protective collar for 3 padlocks, for mushroom Ø 40 mm, can be locked (BKS, CES, O.M.R.) B 3SB3801-2EC3 1 1 unit 102 For contact blocks, lampholders and accessories with snap-on floor mounting, also single-pole front plate blocks can be used (switching state is maintained upon opening), with gray top part 3SB38 02-0AA3 For EMERGENCY-STOP, for contact blocks, lampholders and accessories with snap-on floor mounting, also single-pole front plate blocks can be used (switching state is maintained upon opening) 3SB38 01-0AB3 Empty enclosures, metal Cable entry top and bottom each 1 x M20 for 1 to 3 command points, each 1 x M25 for 4 and 6 command points For contact blocks, lampholders and accessories with snap-on floor mounting, also single-pole front plate blocks can be used (switching state is maintained upon opening), with gray top part 3SB38 04-2AA3 3SB38 01-2AB3 3SB38 01-2AD3 3SB38 01-2EC3 1) The protective collar must only be used to protect against inadvertent actuating and must be fitted to allow unimpeded access to the EMERGENCYSTOP mushroom pushbutton. * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/89 10 For EMERGENCY-STOP, for contact blocks, lampholders and accessories with snap-on floor mounting, also single-pole front plate blocks can be used (switching state is maintained upon opening) © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Enclosures Customer-specific enclosures ■ Overview Customized enclosures are available with: • 1 to 6 command points • Operational voltage up to 400 V. One command point comprises: • 1 actuator or indicator • Up to 3 contact blocks or up to 2 contact blocks + 1 lampholder • 1 inscription label For plastic enclosures the command points are equipped as standard with plastic actuators and indicators, for metal enclosures they are equipped with metal actuators and indicators. For routing the cable in, one hole for M20 (for 1 to 3 command points) or for M25 (for 4 or 6 command points) is provided at the top and bottom. Ordering notes (selection by configurator) To order customized enclosures with the 3SB3 control devices, use the 3SB configurator to select the blocks for equipping. An electronic order form will be generated for the additional options. The configurator is available in the interactive catalog CA 01 on DVD or in the Industry Mall on the Internet: www.siemens.com/industrymall Supplement the Order No. with the order code "K0Y" (as already listed in the selection table). The list price of the complete enclosure is generated in the configurator for the customized equipment. Please send the resulting electronic order form along with your order by e-mail to our Competence Center at sirius-attach.aud@siemens.com If you are unable to access either catalog, please contact our Technical Assistance. ■ Selection and ordering data Version Number of DT Order No. command points With contact blocks and lampholders for floor mounting 1 2 3 4 6 C C C B B With single-pole contact blocks and lampholders for 1 front plate mounting 2 3 4 6 With contact blocks and lampholders for floor mounting Price per PU1) PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG 3SB3801-0AZK0Y 3SB3802-0AZK0Y 3SB3803-0AZK0Y 3SB3804-0AZK0Y 3SB3806-0AZK0Y 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 C C C B B 3SB3801-1AZK0Y 3SB3802-1AZK0Y 3SB3803-1AZK0Y 3SB3804-1AZK0Y 3SB3806-1AZK0Y 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 1 2 3 4 6 C C C C C 3SB3801-2AZK0Y 3SB3802-2AZK0Y 3SB3803-2AZK0Y 3SB3804-2AZK0Y 3SB3806-2AZK0Y 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 With single-pole contact blocks and lampholders for 1 front plate mounting 2 3 4 6 C C C C C 3SB3801-3AZK0Y 3SB3802-3AZK0Y 3SB3803-3AZK0Y 3SB3804-3AZK0Y 3SB3806-3AZK0Y 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 Suspended pushbuttons With holding plate and handle, customized equipment D 3SB3887-1AZK0Y 1 1 unit 102 Plastic enclosures 3SB38 03-.AZ 10 Metal enclosures 3SB38 03-.AZ 1) max. 6 The prices depend on the equipment selected in the configurator. 10/90 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Enclosures Contact blocks and lampholders ■ Selection and ordering data For self-equipping of the enclosures Version Rated voltage/ Diagram Operating travel/color DT Screw terminals Contact closed Order No. Contact open PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG Price per PU Contact blocks for floor mounting Contact blocks with one contact 3 1 NO with gold-plated contacts 1 NC with gold-plated contacts 1) 1 2 1 1 unit 102 3SB3420-0BA 1 1 unit 102 } 3SB3420-0C 1 1 unit 102 C 3SB3420-0CA 1 1 unit 102 } 3SB3420-1A 1 1 unit 102 Clear B 3SB3420-1C 1 1 unit 102 Yellow Red Green Blue White B } } B } 3SB3420-1PA 3SB3420-1PB 3SB3420-1PC 3SB3420-1PD 3SB3420-1PE 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 Yellow Red Green Blue White B B B D B 3SB3420-1QA 3SB3420-1QB 3SB3420-1QC 3SB3420-1QD 3SB3420-1QE 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 Yellow Red Green Blue White B B B B B 3SB3420-1RA 3SB3420-1RB 3SB3420-1RC 3SB3420-1RD 3SB3420-1RE 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 Black Blue Green/Yellow B B B 3SB3901-0AG 3SB3901-0AH 3SB3901-0AJ 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 2 3 4 2,3 NSD0_00017 NSD00007 3SB34 20-0B 1) 3SB3420-0B B 3-4 0 1 mm 4 1 NC } NSD0_00015 NSD00006 1 NO 1-2 0 1 mm 2 3 4 1,6 BA 9s lampholders Without lamp Acc. to lamp X1 (L+) X2 (L-) NSD00003 230/240 V AC With integrated voltage reducer and with 130 V lamp X2 X1 (3SX1 731)2) 3SB34 20-1A NSD00042 Lampholders with integrated LED 24 V AC/DC X1 k X2 k + NSD0_01292b 110 V AC X1 k 3SB34 20-1PE k + X2 X1 k k + X2 NSD0_01296b Fixpoint terminals 3SB39 01-0AH 1) Positive opening according to IEC 60947-5-1, Appendix K. 2) Only use with this lamp. * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/91 10 NSD0_01296b 230 V AC © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Enclosures Contact blocks and lampholders Version Rated voltage/ Diagram Operating travel/color DT Spring-type terminals Contact closed Order No. Contact open PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG Price per PU Contact blocks for floor mounting Contact blocks with one contact 3 1 NO with gold-plated contacts 1 NC with gold-plated contacts 1) 1 2 Lampholders with integrated LED 1 1 unit 102 3SB3423-0BA 1 1 unit 102 B 3SB3423-0C 1 1 unit 102 B 3SB3423-0CA 1 1 unit 102 Yellow Red Green Blue White B B B B B 3SB3423-1PA 3SB3423-1PB 3SB3423-1PC 3SB3423-1PD 3SB3423-1PE 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 Yellow Green Red Blue White B D D D D 3SB3423-1QA 3SB3423-1QC 3SB3423-1QB 3SB3423-1QD 3SB3423-1QE 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 Yellow Blue Green Red White D B B B B 3SB3423-1RA 3SB3423-1RD 3SB3423-1RC 3SB3423-1RB 3SB3423-1RE 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 Black Blue Green/Yellow B B B 3SB3423-2F 3SB3423-2G 3SB3423-2H 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG 100 10 units 102 2 3 4 2,3 NSD0_00017 NSD00007 3SB34 23-0B 1) 3SB3423-0B D 3-4 0 1 mm 4 1 NC B NSD0_00015 NSD00006 1 NO 1-2 0 1 mm 24 V AC/DC X1 k X2 k + 2 3 4 1,6 NSD0_01292b 110 V AC X1 k k + X2 NSD0_01296b 230 V AC X1 k k + X2 NSD0_01296b 10 Fixpoint terminals 3SB34 23-2G 1) Positive opening according to IEC 60947-5-1, Appendix K. Version DT Order No. Price per PU Accessories Pressure plates for selector switches and key-operated switches B For actuating the central contact block of 3 contact blocks 3SB3901-0AW 3SB39 01-0AW 10/92 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Enclosures Inscription labels for enclosures ■ Overview Black labels The inscription labels (black with white inscription or silver-colored with black print) have an adhesive layer on the back. The size of the labels is 22 mm × 22 mm. Inscriptions The inscriptions have upper case initial letters. The typeface is Arial. Graphic symbols, including those not listed in the catalog, are according to ISO 7000 or IEC 60417 (see page 10/94). ■ Selection and ordering data PU (UNIT) = 1 PS* = 10 units (customized inscription: 1 unit) PG = 102 Inscriptions DT Black Order No. DT Silver-colored Price per PU Order No. Price per PU Inscription labels, self-adhesive, 22 mm × 22 mm For self-inscription } 3SB3906-1AA B 3SB1901-3AA Ein On Aus Off B B B B 3SB3906-1AB 3SB3906-1EB 3SB3906-1AC 3SB3906-1EC B B B B 3SB1901-3AB 3SB1901-3EB 3SB1901-3AC 3SB1901-3EC Auf Up Ab Down B B B B 3SB3906-1AD 3SB3906-1ED 3SB3906-1AE 3SB3906-1EE B B B B 3SB1901-3AD 3SB1901-3ED 3SB1901-3AE 3SB1901-3EE Auf Open Zu Close B B B B 3SB3906-1AD 3SB3906-1EP 3SB3906-1AL 3SB3906-1EQ B B B B 3SB1901-3AD 3SB1901-3EP 3SB1901-3AL 3SB1901-3EQ Vor Forward Zurück Reverse B B B B 3SB3906-1AF 3SB3906-1EF 3SB3906-1AG 3SB3906-1EG B B B B 3SB1901-3AF 3SB1901-3EF 3SB1901-3AG 3SB1901-3EG Rechts Right Links Left B B B B 3SB3906-1AH 3SB3906-1EH 3SB3906-1AJ 3SB3906-1EJ B 3SB1901-3AH -3SB1901-3AJ -- Schnell Fast Langsam Slow B B B B 3SB3906-1AM 3SB3906-1ER 3SB3906-1AN 3SB3906-1ES B Betrieb Running Störung Fault B B B B 3SB3906-1AP 3SB3906-1EV 3SB3906-1AQ 3SB3906-1EW B B B 3SB1901-3AP 3SB1901-3EV 3SB1901-3AQ -- Einrichten Start Reset Test B B B B 3SB3906-1AR 3SB3906-1EL 3SB3906-1EM 3SB3906-1EN B B B B 3SB1901-3AR 3SB1901-3EL 3SB101-3EM 3SB19 01-3EN Halt Stop NOT-HALT NOT-AUS EMERGENCY STOP B B B B B 3SB3906-1AK 3SB3906-1EK 3SB3906-1AS 3SB3906-1AV 3SB3906-1EY B B B B B 3SB1901-3AK 3SB1901-3EK 3SB1901-3AT 3SB1901-3AS 3SB1901-3EY Fans Pump Cooling Heizung B B B B 3SB3906-1CA 3SB3906-1CB 3SB3906-1CC 3SB3906-1CD B -3SB1901-3CB --- Lighting Filter Motor Compressor B B B B 3SB3906-1CE 3SB3906-1CF 3SB3906-1CG 3SB3906-1CH B X 3SB1901-3CE --3SB1901-3CH O I II III B B B B 3SB3906-1MB 3SB3906-1MC 3SB3906-1MD 3SB3906-1ME B B B B 3SB1901-3MB 3SB1901-3MC 3SB1901-3MD 3SB1901-3ME O I (horizontal) I O II (horizontal) I O (vertical) II O I (vertical) B B B B 3SB3906-1MF 3SB3906-1MG 3SB3906-1MH 3SB3906-1MW B B B C 3SB1901-3MF 3SB1901-3MG 3SB1901-3MH 3SB1901-3MW → B 3SB3906-1NA B 3SB1901-3NA Blank With inscription B 3SB1901-3AM -3SB1901-3AN -- 10 B With graphic symbol * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/93 © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Enclosures Inscription labels for enclosures Inscriptions DT Black Order No. DT Silver-colored Price per PU Order No. Price per PU Inscription labels, self-adhesive, 22 mm × 22 mm With customized inscription 3SB3906-0XZ For inscriptions or symbols see "Options" 3SB1901-3XZ • Text line(s) C K0Y C K0Y • Text line(s) or symbol with No. B K1Y, K2Y, K3Y or K5Y D K1Y, K2Y, K3Y or K5Y • Any inscription or symbol B K9Y D K9Y ■ Options Customized inscriptions Ordering notes The labels can be inscribed with text and symbols not listed in the ordering data. Append the following codes to the Order No.: • Text line in upper/lower case, always upper case for beginning of line (e.g. "Lift off"): K0Y • Text line(s) in upper case (e.g. "LIFT OFF"): K1Y • Text line(s) in lower case (e.g. "lift off"): K2Y • Text line(s) in upper/lower case, all words begin with upper case letters (e.g. "Lift Off"): K5Y • Symbol with number according to ISO 7000 or IEC 60417: K3Y • Any inscription or symbol according to order form supplement: K9Y A letter height of 4 mm is used as standard for text inscriptions (1 to 3 lines) Up to 11 characters per line are possible. The typeface used is Arial. Other letter heights and typefaces are possible, but must be specified when ordering. Examples for customized inscription When ordering, specify the required inscription in plain text in addition to the order number and order code. In the case of special inscriptions with words in languages other than German, give the exact spelling and specify the language. Two-line inscription in upper/lower case lettering (K0Y) In the case of multi-line inscriptions, the text must be assigned to the respective line, e.g. "Z1 = Lift, Z2 =Lower". For long words you can also specify the end-of-line division (see ordering example 1). 10 Symbols can also be ordered with numbers according to ISO 7000 or IEC 60417 (see ordering example 2 and 3). Single-line inscription in upper case lettering (K1Y) For special symbols (order code K9Y), a CAD drawing in DXF format can be submitted. Ordering example 1 A label with 2 lines of text is required: 3SB39 06–0XZ K1Y Z1 = LIFT Z2 = LOWER Three-line inscription in lower case letters (K2Y) Ordering example 2 A label inscribed with symbol No. 5011 according to IEC 60417 is required: 3SB39 06–0XZ K3Y Z = 5011 IEC Ordering example 3 Symbol number 5011 according to IEC 60417 (K3Y) A label inscribed with symbol No. 1118 according to ISO 7000 is required: 3SB39 06–0XZ K3Y Z = 1118 ISO Any symbol according to order form supplement (K9Y) 10/94 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 Illustrations are approximate © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Enclosures Accessories for enclosures ■ Selection and ordering data Version Color/ inscription DT Order No. Blanking plugs For plastic version, round Black } Blanking plugs (plastic) For metal version, round Aluminized Price per PU PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG 3SB3921-0AA 1 10 units 102 B 3SB1902-0AQ 1 10 units 102 Holders for pushbuttons and switches1) For snapping on 3 blocks, for front plate mounting } 3SB3901-0AB 100 20 units 102 Holders for selector switches and keyoperated switches with pressure plate For actuating a central contact block, for front plate mounting } 3SB3901-0AC 100 10 units 102 Pressure plates for selector switches and key-operated switches For actuating a central contact block, for floor mounting B 3SB3901-0AW 100 10 units 102 D 3SB1902-1AQ 1 1 unit 102 Blanking plugs for spare command points 3SB39 21-0AA 3SB19 02-0AQ Holders and pressure plates 3SB39 01-0AB 3SB39 01-0AC 3SB39 01-0AW Yellow name plates Without inscription As backing plate for EMERGENCY-STOP, With inscription self-adhesive • NOT-HALT B 3SB1902-2AQ 1 1 unit 102 • NOT-AUS B 3SB3921-0CJ 1 1 unit 102 With recess for inscription label B 3SB3921-0BV 1 1 unit 102 M20 cable glands Incl. hexagonal nut B 3SB3901-0CK 1 1 unit 102 M25 cable glands incl. hexagonal nut B 3SB3901-0CM 1 1 unit 102 M20 hexagonal nuts For cable glands B 3SB3901-0CL 100 10 units 102 M25 hexagonal nuts For cable glands B 3SB3901-0CN 100 10 units 102 3SB39 01-0CK 3SB39 01-0CL Connecting pieces For connecting 2 plastic enclosures 3SB39 01-0C • M20/M20 B 3SB3901-0CS 1 1 unit 102 • M20/M25 B 3SB3901-0CT 1 1 unit 102 • M25/M25 B 3SB3901-0CU 1 1 unit 102 Connecting pieces For connecting 2 metal enclosures • M20/M20 B 3SB3901-0CP 1 1 unit 102 • M20/M25 B 3SB3901-0CQ 1 1 unit 102 Enclosure nuts For plastic version B 3SB3931-0AB 1 10 units 102 3SB39 01-0C 3SB39 01-0AB 1) The holder for illuminated commanding devices is included in the scope of supply. * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/95 10 Accessories for enclosures © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Enclosures for AS-Interface General data ■ Overview Installation of AS-Interface slaves The following slave types are available for connecting the command points: • Slave in A/B technology with 4 inputs and 3 outputs • Slave with 4 inputs and 4 outputs • F slave with 2 safe inputs for EMERGENCY-STOP The following table shows the maximum number of equippable slaves: AS-Interface enclosure with customized equipment Distributed command devices of the 3SB3 series can be quickly connected to the AS-Interface using AS-Interface enclosures. Using suitable components you can make your own enclosures with integrated AS-Interface or flexibly modify existing enclosures. Enclosures for Number of slaves for enclosures without EMERGENCYSTOP Number of slaves for enclosures with EMERGENCY-STOP 1 command point Not available 1 x F slave 2 command points 1 x slave 4I/4O or 4I/3O Not available 3 command points 1 x slave 4I/4O or 4I/3O 1 x slave 4I/4O or 4I/3O + 1 x F slave 4 command points 2 x slave 4I/4O or 4I/3O1) 2 × slave 4I/4O or 4I/3O + 1 × F slave1) 6 command points 2 x slave 4I/4O or 4I/3O 2 x slave 4I/4O or 4I/3O + 1 x F slave 1) For metal enclosures with 4 command points, only 1 x slave 4I/4O or 4I/3O is possible. Connection One set of links is required in each case to connect a slave to contact blocks, to lampholders and to the connection element. NSD0_01414 10 The connection elements are mounted in the front-end cable glands and are used for connection of the AS-Interface or for bringing unused inputs or outputs out of the enclosure. EMERGENCY-STOP enclosure Enclosures Color of enclosure cover: • Gray, RAL 7035, or • Yellow, RAL 1004, for EMERGENCY-STOP. Color of enclosure base: • Black, RAL 9005 For connection to the AS-Interface bus there is a choice of the following options: • Terminal for shaped AS-Interface cable. The cable is contacted by the insulation piercing method and routed past the enclosure on the outside (possible only with plastic enclosure). • Cable gland for the shaped AS-Interface cable or round cable. The cable is routed into the enclosure (preferable for metal enclosure). • Connection using M12 plug. If less than all inputs/outputs of the installed slaves in an enclosure are used for connecting the command devices, free inputs and outputs can be routed on request to the outside through an M12 socket on the top or bottom side of the enclosure. To supply inputs with power, the S+ connection of the must be assigned to the socket, for outputs the OUT– connection must be assigned. Addressing is performed using the AS-Interface connections or the integrated addressing socket. An external power supply is not required. Customized enclosures (selection by configurator) To order customized 3SF58 AS-Interface enclosures with the 3SB3 control devices, use the 3SB/3SF configurator to select the blocks for equipping. An electronic order form will be generated for the additional options. For ordering notes see page 10/90. 10/96 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Enclosures for AS-Interface AS-Interface enclosures with standard fittings ■ Overview Enclosures with standard fittings are available with: • 1 to 3 command points • Operational voltage through AS-Interface (approx. 30 V) • Vertical mounting type • Plastic enclosures are equipped with plastic actuators and indicators, metal enclosures are equipped with metal actuators and indicators. EMERGENCY-STOP enclosures are fitted with two NC contact blocks, which are wired to the safe slave. The contact blocks and lampholders (with spring-type terminals) of the control device, and the AS-Interface slaves, are mounted in the base of the enclosure and are cable-connected. The plastic versions of the enclosures have a connection for the AS-Interface flat cable (the cable is routed past the enclosure on the outside); in the case of the metal versions the AS-Interface cable is routed into the enclosure. The actuators/indicators are fixed with an enclosure nut. If required it can be disassembled with a 27 mm socket wrench or with a 3SX17 07 ring nut wrench. The EMERGENCY-STOP enclosures can also be supplied with an M12 connector in place of the gland. The enclosures without EMERGENCY-STOP each have one user module with 4I/3O; the enclosures with EMERGENCY-STOP have a safe AS-Interface slave integrated in the enclosure. ■ Selection and ordering data Equipping options (A, B, C = identification letters of the command points) No. of command points DT Order No. Price PU (UNIT, per PU SET, M) PS* PG B 3SF5811-0AA10 1 1 unit 121 AS-Interface enclosures, plastic With M12 top connector A = EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbuttons, with rotate-to-unlatch mechanism, 1 NC, 1 NC, yellow enclosure top 1 With terminal for insulation piercing method at top 3SF5 812-0DA00 • Yellow enclosure top • Yellow enclosure top, with protective collar 1 1 A 3SF5811-0AA08 A 3SF5811-0AB08 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 121 121 B = Pushbutton green, label "I", 1 NO A = Pushbutton red, label "O", 1 NO 2 A 3SF5812-0DA00 1 1 unit 121 B = Pushbutton white, label "I", 1 NO A = Pushbutton black, label "O", 1 NO 2 A 3SF5812-0DB00 1 1 unit 121 C = Indicator lights clear, label without inscription B = Pushbutton green, label "I", 1 NO A = Pushbutton red, label "O", 1 NO 3 A 3SF5813-0DA00 1 1 unit 121 C = Indicator lights clear, label without inscription B = Pushbutton white, label "I", 1 NO A = Pushbutton black, label "O", 1 NO 3 A 3SF5813-0DC00 1 1 unit 121 C = Pushbutton black, label "II", 1 NO B = Pushbutton black, label "I", 1 NO A = Pushbutton red, label "O", 1 NO 3 A 3SF5813-0DB00 1 1 unit 121 1 1 C 3SF5811-2AA10 C 3SF5811-2AB10 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 121 121 • Yellow enclosure top • Yellow enclosure top, with protective collar 1 1 A 3SF5811-2AA08 A 3SF5811-2AB08 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 121 121 B = Pushbutton green, label "I", 1 NO A = Pushbutton red, label "O", 1 NO 2 A 3SF5812-2DA00 1 1 unit 121 B = Pushbutton white, label "I", 1 NO A = Pushbutton black, label "O", 1 NO 2 A 3SF5812-2DB00 1 1 unit 121 C = Indicator lights clear, label without inscription B = Pushbutton green, label "I", 1 NO A = Pushbutton red, label "O", 1 NO 3 A 3SF5813-2DA00 1 1 unit 121 C = Indicator lights clear, label without inscription B = Pushbutton white, label "I", 1 NO A = Pushbutton black, label "O", 1 NO 3 A 3SF5813-2DC00 1 1 unit 121 C = Pushbutton black, label "II", 1 NO B = Pushbutton black, label "I", 1 NO A = Pushbutton red, label "O", 1 NO 3 A 3SF5813-2DB00 1 1 unit 121 AS-Interface enclosures, metal With M12 top connector A = EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbuttons, with rotate-to-unlatch mechanism, 1 NC, 1 NC • Yellow enclosure top • Yellow enclosure top, with protective collar With cable gland at top 3SF5 811-2AB08 3SF5 813-2DA00 A = EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbuttons, with rotate-to-unlatch mechanism, 1 NC, 1 NC * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/97 10 3SF5 811-0AA08 A = EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbuttons, with rotate-to-unlatch mechanism, 1 NC, 1 NC © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm Enclosures for AS-Interface Components for AS-Interface enclosures ■ Selection and ordering data For self-equipping of the enclosures Version Number of command points DT Order No. F slave, 2 safe inputs, for plastic enclosure, EMERGENCY-STOP, without protective collar 1 ... 6 A F slave, 2 safe inputs, for plastic or metal enclosure, EMERGENCY-STOP, with protective collar 1 A/B slave, 4I/3O for plastic enclosure Slave, 4I/4O, for plastic enclosure Price per PU PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG 3SF5500-0BA 1 1 unit 121 A 3SF5500-0DA 1 1 unit 121 2 ... 6 A 3SF5500-0BB 1 1 unit 121 2 ... 6 A 3SF5500-0BC 1 1 unit 121 For F slave A 3SF5900-0BA 1 1 unit 121 For slave 4I/4O or A/B slave 4I(3O) A 3SF5900-0BB 1 1 unit 121 For plastic enclosures AS-Interface slaves 3SF5 500-0BA 3SF5 500-0BB Sets of links 3SF5 900-0CA 3SF5 900-0CC 3SF5 900-0CG Connection elements For AS-Interface shaped cable, connection by insulation piercing method, for plastic enclosure 1 ... 3 A 3SF5900-0CA 1 1 unit 121 4 ... 6 B 3SF5900-0CB 1 1 unit 121 For AS-Interface connection using M12 plug, for plastic enclosure 1 ... 3 B 3SF5900-0CC 1 1 unit 121 4 ... 6 B 3SF5900-0CD 1 1 unit 121 For bringing out unused inputs/outputs through an M12 1 ... 3 socket, for plastic enclosure 4 ... 6 For AS-Interface shaped cable, 1 ... 3 cable is routed into the enclosure, 4 ... 6 for plastic or metal enclosure B 3SF5900-0CE 1 1 unit 121 B 3SF5900-0CF 1 1 unit 121 A 3SF5900-0CG 1 1 unit 121 A 3SF5900-0CH 1 1 unit 121 For round cable, cable is routed into the enclosure, for plastic or metal enclosure 1 ... 3 A 3SF5900-0CJ 1 1 unit 121 4 ... 6 A 3SF5900-0CK 1 1 unit 121 F slave, 2 safe inputs, for metal enclosure, EMERGENCY-STOP, without protective collar 1 ... 6 A 3SF5500-0CA 1 1 unit 121 F slave, 2 safe inputs, for plastic or metal enclosure, EMERGENCY-STOP, with protective collar 1 A 3SF5500-0DA 1 1 unit 121 For metal enclosures 10 AS-Interface slaves 3SF5 500-0CB A/B slave, 4I/3O, for metal enclosure 2 ... 6 A 3SF5500-0CB 1 1 unit 121 Slave, 4I/4O, for metal enclosure 2 ... 6 A 3SF5500-0CC 1 1 unit 121 For F slave A 3SF5900-0BA 1 1 unit 121 For slave 4I/4O or A/B slave 4I(3O) A 3SF5900-0BB 1 1 unit 121 1 ... 3 B 3SF5900-2CC 1 1 unit 121 4 ... 6 B 3SF5900-2CD 1 1 unit 121 For bringing out unused inputs/outputs through an M12 1 ... 3 socket, for metal enclosure 4 ... 6 For AS-Interface shaped cable, 1 ... 3 cable is routed into the enclosure, 4 ... 6 for plastic or metal enclosure B 3SF5900-2CE 1 1 unit 121 B 3SF5900-2CF 1 1 unit 121 A 3SF5900-0CG 1 1 unit 121 A 3SF5900-0CH 1 1 unit 121 For round cable, cable is routed into the enclosure, for plastic or metal enclosure 1 ... 3 A 3SF5900-0CJ 1 1 unit 121 4 ... 6 A 3SF5900-0CK 1 1 unit 121 Sets of links Connection elements 3SF5 900-0CG 3SF5 900-0CJ 10/98 For AS-Interface connection using M12 plug, for metal enclosure Siemens IC 10 · 2011 * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate © Siemens AG 2010 3SB3 Two-Hand Operation Consoles Plastic and metal enclosures The standard equipment comprises: • 2 black mushroom pushbuttons, Ø 40 mm, 1 NO + 1 NC, Order No. 3SB30 00-1GA11 or 3SB35 00-1GA11 • 1 red EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbutton according to ISO 13850, Ø 40 mm, with positive latching, 2 NC, Order No. 3SB30 00-1HA20 or 3SB35 00-1HA20. ■ Overview The plastic version can be retrofitted with up to 8 customized command points. The surface of the console has premachined breaking points for this purpose. ■ Application The two-hand operation consoles are required for use with machines and systems that have hazardous areas, in order to direct both hands of the operator to one position. Operator panels are primarily used on presses, stamping machines, printing presses and paper converting machines, in the chemical industry and in the rubber and plastics industries. Two-hand operation console with metal enclosure Equipment The two-hand operation consoles are pre-equipped with 3SB3 command devices. In the case of plastic enclosures the command points are equipped as standard with actuators and indicators made of plastic, in the case of metal enclosures they are equipped with actuators and indicators made of metal. The control command is given by pressing the two mushroom pushbuttons on the sides simultaneously (within 0.5 s of each other) and must be maintained for as long as a hazard exists. For the further processing of control commands, suitable evaluation units are used, e.g. 3TK28 3 safety relays (see Safety Relays in chapter 7). Standards The two-hand operation consoles comply with the requirements of EN 574. ■ Selection and ordering data Version DT Order No. Price per PU PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG Metal enclosures, degree of protection IP65 • With standard fittings B 3SB3863-4BB 1 1 unit 102 • With standard fittings and 4 additional holes for 22.5 mm command devices1) B 3SB3863-4BA 1 1 unit 102 • Empty enclosure, unequipped B 3SB3863-4BC 1 1 unit 102 Two-hand operation consoles, plastic enclosure B With standard fittings and premachined breaking points for 8 additional 22.5 mm1) command devices, with holes for metric cable glands 3SB3863-1BB3 1 1 unit 102 Stands for two-hand operation consoles With holes for metric cable glands 3SB3901-0AQ3 1 1 unit 102 3SB38 63-4BB Plastic enclosures, degree of protection IP65 3SB38 63-1BB3 Accessories B 3SB39 01-0AQ 1) See 3SB3 pushbuttons and indicator lights. * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/99 10 Two-hand operation consoles, metal enclosure © Siemens AG 2010 3SE7, 3SF2 Cable-Operated Switches 3SE7 metal enclosures Contact blocks ■ Overview The switches for wire lengths up to 50 m are supplied with 1 NO + 1 NC or 2 NC contacts and those up to 75 m with 1 NO + 3 NC contacts. The switches for wire lengths from 2 × 75 m and the conveyor belt unbalance protection device are supplied with 2 NO + 2 NC contacts. The NC contacts of the cable-break or cable-pull signaling are positive opening. The NO contact can be used, for example, for signaling purposes. Free position and indication Cable-operated switches with one-side operation are held in free position by the pre-tension on the turnbuckle. On switches with interlocking, with a pretensioned cable, the locking must be deactivated beforehand in order to return the cable-operated switch to its original position. The cable-operated switch and the conveyor belt unbalance tracker can be supplied optionally with a factory-fitted LED (red, 24 V DC). This light in innovative chip-on-board technology allows the operating state of the switch to be visible at a distance of at least 50 m. Cable-operated switches The cable-operated switches are used for monitoring or for EMERGENCY-STOP devices on particularly endangered system sections. ■ Application As the effective range of a cable-operated switch is only limited by the length of the trip-wire, large systems can also be protected. Cable-operated switches (requiring pulling at both ends) and conveyor belt unbalance trackers are used primarily for monitoring very long belt systems. Standards The switches are equipped with positive latching and positive NC contacts and are thus suitable for operation in EMERGENCYSTOP devices according to EN ISO 13850. ■ Technical specifications Type 3SE7 120 3SE7 150 3SE7 140 3SE7 141 3SE7 160 3SE7 310 10 General data Standards IEC 60947-5-1, EN 60947-5-1; IEC 60204-1, EN 60204-1; EN ISO 13850 Approvals UL/CSA Electrical design Contacts electrically isolated from each other Electrical load • 2-pole, at AC-15 400 V AC, 6 A 400 V AC, 6 A 250 V AC, 2 A 400 V AC, 6 A -- • 3-pole, at AC-15 250 V AC, 2 A -- -- -- -- • 4-pole, at AC-15 -- -- -- 400 V AC, 6 A 400 V AC, 6 A • Min. 24 V AC/DC, 10 mA 75 2 × 75 – Short-circuit protection A 6 (slow) Mechanical endurance > 1 million operating cycles Contact material Fine silver Operation By pulling or breaking of wire Wire length, maximum m 10 25 50 Distance between wire supports, max. m 2.5 3 5 – Enclosures Enclosure material GD Al alloy, coated (color), dark black RAL 9005 Cover Shock-resistant thermoplast Degree of protection acc. to EN 60529 Ambient temperature IP65 °C Mounting IP65 3 × (M20 × 1.5) 2 × (M25 × 1.5) Designed for M5 Fixing spacing mm 30 and 40 Cable entry 2 × (M20 × 1.5) Connection type Screw terminals M3.5, self-lifting clamp terminal 10/100 IP67 –25 ... +70 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 1 × (M16 × 1.5) © Siemens AG 2010 3SE7, 3SF2 Cable-Operated Switches 3SE7 metal enclosures ■ Selection and ordering data Version Wire length Contacts DT Order No. Price per PU PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG m Cable-operated switches Metal enclosures, IP65 (cover made of molded plastic) 10 • Without latching, only cable pull monitoring 1 NO + 1 NC 1) A 3SE7120-2DD01 1 1 unit 102 • With latching and button reset 2 NC 1) A 3SE7120-1BF00 1 1 unit 102 1 NO + 2 NC 1) A 3SE7120-1BH00 1 1 unit 102 • Without latching 1 NO + 1 NC 1) A 3SE7150-2DD00 1 1 unit 102 • With latching and button reset 1 NO + 1 NC 1) A 3SE7150-1BD00 1 1 unit 102 2 NC 1) A 3SE7150-1BF00 1 1 unit 102 1 NO + 2 NC 1) B 3SE7150-1BH00 1 1 unit 102 1 NO + 1 NC 1) B 3SE7150-1CD00 1 1 unit 102 • Without latching 1 NO + 1 NC 1) B 3SE7150-2DD04 1 1 unit 102 • With latching and button reset 1 NO + 1 NC 1) B 3SE7150-1BD04 1 1 unit 102 1 NO + 1 NC 1) A 3SE7140-1BD00 1 1 unit 102 2 NC 1) B 3SE7140-1BF00 1 1 unit 102 • In addition with LED, red, 24 V DC 1 NO + 1 NC 1) B 3SE7140-1BD04 1 1 unit 102 • With latching and key unlatching 1 NO + 1 NC 1) B 3SE7140-1CD00 1 1 unit 102 1 NO + 3 NC 1) A 3SE7141-1EG10 1 1 unit 102 - With yellow lid 3SE7 120-1BH00 Metal enclosures, IP65 (cover made of molded plastic), with dust protection and alignment window 25 - With yellow lid • With latching and key unlatching 3SE7 150-1BD00 3SE7 150-1BH00 Metal enclosures, IP65 (cover made of molded plastic), with dust protection and alignment window, with LED, red, 24 V DC 25 3SE7 150-1BD04 50 • With latching and button reset 3SE7 140-1B.00 Metal enclosures, IP67 (cover made of molded plastic), with EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom, rotate-to-unlatch mechanism 75 Metal enclosures, IP65 With actuation on both sides 2 × 75 3SE7 141-1EG10 • With latching and button reset • In addition with LED, red, 24 V DC 2 NO + 2 NC 1) A 3SE7160-1AE00 1 1 unit 102 1 NO + 1 NC 1) B 3SE7160-1BD00 1 1 unit 102 2 NO + 2 NC 1) B 3SE7160-1AE04 1 1 unit 102 3SE7 160-1AE00 1) Positive opening according to IEC 60947-5-1, Appendix K. * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/101 10 Metal enclosures, IP65 (cover made of molded plastic), with dust protection © Siemens AG 2010 3SE7, 3SF2 Cable-Operated Switches 3SE7 metal enclosures Version Wire length Contacts DT Order No. Price per PU PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG m Conveyor belt unbalance trackers Metal enclosures, IP65 • With latching and button reset 2 NO + 2 NC 1) B 3SE7310-1AE00 1 1 unit 102 • In addition with LED, red, 24 V DC 2 NO + 2 NC 1) B 3SE7310-1AE04 1 1 unit 102 3SE7 310-1AE00 1) Positive opening according to IEC 60947-5-1, Appendix K. ■ Accessories Configuration of the cable-operated switches Short lengths of wire up to 25 m Wire clamp, simplex, oval, Ø4 mm 3SE7 941-1AC Wire clamp, simplex, oval, Ø4 mm 3SE7 941-1AC Wire eye, Ø4 mm 3SE7 930-1AC Wire eye, Ø4 mm 3SE7 930-1AC Wire, Wire clamp, simplex, Ø4 mm oval, 3SE7 910 Ø4 mm 3SE7 941-1AC Turnbuckle M6 x 60 3SE7 950-1AB Eyebolt M8 3SE7 920-1AB Wire clamp, simplex, oval, Ø4 mm 3SE7 941-1AC Eyebolt M8 3SE7 9201AB Wire eye, Ø4 mm 3SE7 930-1AC Wire eye, Ø4 mm 3SE7 930-1AC NSC0_00288d SIRIUS cable-operated switch 3SE7 120 3SE7 150 Wire clamp, simplex, oval, Ø4 mm 3SE7 941-1AC Wire eye, Ø4 mm 3SE7 930-1AD Wire clamp, Wire clamp, Turnbuckle simplex, simplex, M6 x 60 oval, oval, 3SE7 950-1AB Ø4 mm Ø4 mm 3SE7 3SE7 941-1AC 941-1AC Wire eye, Ø4 mm Wire eye, Ø4 mm 3SE7 930-1AD 3SE7 930-1AD Use of a tension spring is essential for lengths of wire Wire, Ø4 mm 3SE7 910 Wire clamp, Tension spring simplex, 35 N oval, 3SE7 931-1AD Ø4 mm 3SE7 941-1AC Wire roller, rotatable 3SE7 921-1AC Eyebolt M10 3SE7 9201AC Wire eye, Ø4 mm 3SE7 930-1AD 25 m. NSC0_00289f SIRIUS cable-operated switch 3SE7 140 Pulling from both sides up to 2 x 75 m Wire, Ø4 mm 3SE7 910 Tension spring up to 2 x 50 m: 3SE7 931-1AD up to 2 x 75 m: 3SE7 931-1AE Eyebolt M10 3SE7 920-1AC Wire Wire clamp, Wire clamp, Turnbuckle simplex,oval, M6 x 60 clamp, simplex, Ø4 mm oval, 3SE7 950-1AB simplex, 3SE7 941-1AC oval, Ø4 mm Ø4 mm 3SE7 3SE7 941941-1AC 1AC Wire roller, rotatable Wire roller, rotatable 3SE7 921-1AC 3SE7 921-1AC Wire eye, Ø4 mm 3SE7 930-1AD SIGUARD cable-operated switch 3SE7 160 Wire eye, Ø4 mm 3SE7 930-1AD Wire Wire Tension spring clamp, clamp, up to 2 x 50 m: simplex, simplex, 3SE7 931-1AD oval, oval, up to 2 x 75 m: Ø4 mm Ø4 mm 3SE7 931-1AE 3SE7 3SE7 941-1AC 941-1AC Wire rollers, rotatable 3SE7 921-1AC Wire eye, Ø4 mm 3SE7 930-1AD Use of a tension spring is essential for lengths of wire 25 m. Note: Large temperature fluctuations require corresponding compensation springs. For reliable connection the PVC sheath must be 10/102 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 NSC0_00499e 10 Long lengths of wire up to 50 m removed from the clamping area of the steel bowden wire. Bowden wire supports must be used at the recommended intervals. * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate © Siemens AG 2010 3SE7, 3SF2 Cable-Operated Switches 3SE7 metal enclosures Version Wire length/ diameter DT Order No. Price per PU PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG Trip-wires with fixing Steel wires, with red plastic sheath, Ø 4 mm1) 10 m A 3SE7910-3AA 1 1 unit 102 15 m A 3SE7910-3AB 1 1 unit 102 20 m A 3SE7910-3AC 1 1 unit 102 50 m A 3SE7910-3AH 1 1 unit 102 • Oval 2 × Ø 4 mm A 3SE7941-1AC 1 1 unit 102 • Simplex (1 set = 4 units) 2 × Ø 4 mm A 3SE7943-1AC 1 4 units 102 • Duplex (1 set = 4 units) 2 × Ø 4 mm A 3SE7944-1AC 1 4 units 102 • Single (1 set = 4 units) 2 × Ø 4 mm A 3SE7942-1AA 1 4 units 102 Wire clamps, galvanized white • 13 N A 3SE7931-1AB 1 1 unit 102 • 35 N, for bowden wires up to 50 m A 3SE7931-1AD 1 1 unit 102 • > 35 N, for bowden wires up to 2 × 75 m B 3SE7931-1AE 1 1 unit 102 A 3SE7921-1AC 1 1 unit 102 A 3SE7921-1AA 1 1 unit 102 A 3SE7930-1AD 1 4 units 102 • Including M8 nut A 3SE7920-1AB 1 1 unit 102 • Including M10 nut A 3SE7920-1AC 1 1 unit 102 Wire rollers for changing the direction of the wire, rotatable Ø 4 mm Fixtures for the wire rollers (incl. fixing nuts) Wire eyes for changes in wire direction and improved power transmission at the fixing points (1 set = 4 units) Ø 4 mm Eyebolts for fixing the wire Turnbuckles for precise adjustment of the pretension • M6 x 60 A 3SE7950-1AB 1 1 unit 102 • M6 x 110 A 3SE7950-1AD 1 1 unit 102 LED lamps, red 24 V DC 25 mm diameter; for M20 x 1.5 connection C 3SX3235 1 1 unit 102 Spare parts 1) Diameter including casing; the diameter of the steel wire is 3.2 mm. * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/103 10 Tension springs (zinc-plated) to maintain the counter tension © Siemens AG 2010 3SE7, 3SF2 Cable-Operated Switches 3SF2 cable-operated switches for AS-Interface AS-Interface cable-operated switches can now be directly connected via the standard AS-Interface with safety-oriented communication. ■ Overview The safety functions no longer have to be conventionally wired up. ■ Application SIRIUS cable-operated switches are used for monitoring or for EMERGENCY-STOP devices on particularly endangered system sections. As the effective range of a cable-operated switch is only limited by the length of the trip-wire, large systems can also be protected. Standards The switches with positive latching are suitable for operation in EMERGENCY-STOP devices in according to ISO 13850. They can achieve up to category 4 according to EN ISO 13849-1 (EN 954-1) or SIL 3 according to IEC 61508. Cable-operated switch with AS-Interface adapter ■ Selection and ordering data Version Basic switches DT Order No. Price per PU PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG ASIsafe cable-operated switches Metal enclosures, IP65 (cover made of molded plastic), with dust protection, latching acc. to ISO 13850, with button reset, 2 NC contacts 3SE7 120-1BF00 C 3SF2120-1BF00-0BA1 1 1 unit 121 • For wire lengths up to 25 m, with alignment window 3SE7 150-1BF00 C 3SF2150-1BF00-0BA1 1 1 unit 121 • For wire lengths up to 50 m 3SE7 140-1BF00 B 3SF2140-1BF00-0BA1 1 1 unit 121 10 • For wire lengths up to 10 m, with alignment window 3SF2 120-1BF00-0BA1 3SF2 150-1BF00-0BA1 3SF2 140-1BF00-0BA1 Positive opening according to IEC 60947-5-1, Appendix K. 10/104 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate © Siemens AG 2010 3SE2, 3SE3 Foot Switches Plastic and metal enclosures ■ Overview The switches have two contact blocks, each with one NO contact and one NC contact. The NO contacts and NC contacts of the two contact blocks are connected for easy connection of a single-phase motor. The normal workflow is initiated by pressing down the pedal as far as the pressure point so that the two NO contacts close and the motor starts to run. If in the event of danger the pedal is pressed beyond the resistance of the pressure point, the positively driven NC contacts will open and the motor is stopped. At the same time the independent latching takes effect and holds the NC contacts in open position. This prevents the machine parts from continuing to run out of control or from being restarted. After the hazard is eliminated, the machine can only be restarted after manually releasing the switch using a pushbutton on the top of the enclosure. The contacts are then released again and return to their initial position (the NO contacts are open and the NC contacts are closed). ■ Technical specifications Standard switches The 3SE2 9 and 3SE3 9 foot switch range encompasses versions in a metal enclosure for rugged applications as well as versions with plastic enclosure for less harsh environments. The devices can be supplied with or without a cover and have fixing holes for them to be screwed to the floor. Depending on the particular application, the metal enclosures can be ordered in latching or momentary-contact versions. The momentary-contact pedal switch in the plastic enclosure has one microswitch (changeover contact) per actuating pedal. Safety foot switches The 3SE2 924-3AA20 single-pedal safety foot switches are used on machines and plants as OK switches when operation by hand is not possible and the EMERGENCY-STOP function must be available if a hazardous status arises. The switches are interlocked according to EN ISO 13850 and bear the CE mark in accordance with the machinery directive. The safety foot switches are protected by a guard hood against accidental operation. Type 3SE29 3SE39 Metal and plastic enclosures Standards IEC 60947-5-1 Electrical load • At AC-15, 400 V A 16 – 6 A for 3SE2903-1…. • At 250 V AC A – 5 Short-circuit protection A 16 (slow) 5 (slow) A 6 (slow) for 3SE2903-1…. Mechanical endurance > 106 operating cycles Material • Enclosures Aluminum casting Impact-resistant thermoplast, self-extinguishing according to UL 94 VO • Cover Thermoplast – • Guard hood Aluminum casting Metal Degree of protection IP65 IP65 Ambient temperature °C -25 ... +80 Connection Cable entry, metric 10 Foot switches with metal enclosures -10 ... +75 Cable AWG20, UL Style 2464, length 3 m Application example Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/105 © Siemens AG 2010 3SE2, 3SE3 Foot Switches Plastic and metal enclosures ■ Selection and ordering data Version Slow-action contacts for each pedal DT Order No. Price per PU PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG Metal enclosures, degree of protection IP65 Momentary-contact foot switches, single pedal M20 x 1.5 cable entry 1 NO + 1 NC 1) A 3SE2902-0AB20 1 1 unit 102 2 NO + 2 NC 1) A 3SE2903-1AB20 1 1 unit 102 1 NO + 1 NC 1) A 3SE2902-0AA20 1 1 unit 102 2 NO + 2 NC 1) A 3SE2903-1AA20 1 1 unit 102 • Without hood 1 NO + 1 NC 1) C 3SE2912-2AB20 1 1 unit 102 • With hood 1 NO + 1 NC 1) C 3SE2912-2AA20 1 1 unit 102 • Without hood • With hood 3SE2 90.-.AA20 3SE2 91.-.AA20 Momentary-contact foot switches, single pedal M20 x 1.5 cable entry Momentary-contact foot switches, two pedals M25 x 1.5 cable entry 1 NO + 1 NC 1) B 3SE2932-0AB20 1 1 unit 102 2 NO + 2 NC 1) B 3SE2932-1AB20 1 1 unit 102 1 NO + 1 NC 1) B 3SE2932-0AA20 1 1 unit 102 2 NO + 2 NC 1) B 3SE2932-1AA20 1 1 unit 102 Safety foot switches, 2 NO + 2 NC single pedal, with hood, M20 x 1.5 cable entry, with interlock according to ISO 13850, NO closes as momentary contact type, NC opens with latching 1) C 3SE2924-3AA20 1 1 unit 102 • Without hood 3SE2 932-.AB20 • With hood 3SE2 932-.AA20 10 3SE2 924-3AA20 Plastic enclosures, degree of protection IP65 Momentary-contact pedal switches, 3 m cable Microswitch • Single pedal 3SE3 902-4CA20 - Without hood 1 CO contact B 3SE3902-4CB20 1 1 unit 102 - With hood 1 CO contact B 3SE3902-4CA20 1 1 unit 102 2 × 1 CO contact B 3SE3934-5CB20 1 1 unit 102 • Two pedals, without hood 3SE3 934-5CB20 1) Positive opening according to IEC 60947-5-1, Appendix K. 10/106 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate © Siemens AG 2010 8WD4 Signaling Columns General data ■ Overview The 8WD4 signaling columns are flexible in design and versatile in use. 1 1 2 3 2 3 4 5 4 6 7 8 9 10 5 11 6 7 15 8 14 9 10 11 8 12 15 13 14 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 NSC0_00727b 13 10 12 NSC0_00726b Acoustic element 8WD42 .0-0FA Light element 8WD42 AS-Interface adapter element 8WD42 28-0BB Connection element 8WD42 08-0AA Bracket for wall mounting 8WD42 08-0CD Adapter for single-hole mounting 8WD42 08-0EH Foot for mounting with pipe 8WD42 08-0DE Pipe 8WD42 08-0EF/8WD43 08-0E. Foot for mounting with pipe 8WD43 08-0DB Foot for mounting with pipe (> 400 mm) 8WD43 08-0DC Adjustable-angle foot for mounting on pipes 8WD44 08-0DF Socket 8WD43 08-0DD Socket (magnetic fixing) 8WD43 08-0DE Bracket for mounting with foot 8WD44 08-0CC 8WD42 signaling columns (width 50 mm) with up to 4 elements 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 16 Acoustic element 8WD44 Light element 8WD44 AS-Interface adapter element 8WD44 28-0BD/8WD44 28-0BE Connection element for mounting on bracket, base and floor 8WD44 08-0AB/8WD44 08-0AE Connection element for mounting on pipe 8WD44 08-0AA/8WD44 08-0AD Bracket for wall mounting 8WD43 08-0CA Bracket for wall mounting (two-sided) 8WD43 08-0CB Socket 8WD43 08-0DD Bracket for base mounting 8WD44 08-0CD Pipe 8WD42 08-0EF/8WD43 08-0E. Foot with pipe 8WD43 08-0DA Foot for mounting with pipe 8WD43 08-0DB Foot for mounting with pipe (> 400 mm) 8WD43 08-0DC Adjustable-angle foot for mounting on pipes 8WD44 08-0DF Socket (magnetic fixing) 8WD43 08-0DE Bracket for mounting with foot 8WD44 08-0CC 8WD44 signaling columns (width 70 mm) with up to 5 elements Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/107 © Siemens AG 2010 8WD4 Signaling Columns General data Two product series are available: • 8WD42 - Thermoplast enclosure, diameter 50 mm - Degree of protection IP54 - Up to 4 elements can be mounted between the connection element and the cover • 8WD44 - Thermoplast enclosure, diameter 70 mm - Advanced design and significantly improved illumination - Fast and flexible connection using spring-type terminals - Integrated degree of protection IP65 - Up to 5 elements can be mounted between the connection element and the cover ■ Application 8WD4 signaling columns are used in machines or in automatic processes for monitoring complex procedures or as visual or acoustic warning devices in emergency situations, e.g. for displaying individual assembly stages. Communication capability Connection to AS-Interface The 8WD4 signaling columns can be directly connected to the AS-Interface bus system through an adapter element that can be integrated. Wiring outlay is reduced as the result. The twowire bus cable is fixed to the screw terminals in the connection element. Up to three signaling elements can be mounted on it using an adapter element. A/B technology enables the connection of up to 62 slaves on one AS-Interface system. Connection The signaling elements are wired up using the screw terminals in the connection element, screw terminals on the 8WD42 and screw or spring-type terminals on the 8WD44. Cable outlet The connecting cables can be guided either downwards or sideways through the cable gland using an adapter that can be screwed under the foot. This makes wiring easier if there is no access from below. Connection to AS-Interface 10 Signaling columns, mounting examples The illustrated examples are from the left: • 8WD42: Cover (no No.), 4 light elements %, connection element (, pipe ,, foot • 8WD44: Cover (no No.), acoustic element $, 2 light elements %, connection element ), foot with pipe / • 8WD44: Cover (no No.), 4 light elements %, AS-Interface adapter element &, connection element (, bracket for wall mounting * • 8WD44: Cover (no No.), 3 light elements %, AS-Interface adapter element &, connection element ), foot with pipe / Note: The cover is supplied with the connection element. ■ Benefits • Choice of various light and acoustic elements with different functions: continuous light, blinklight, flashlight and rotating light; buzzer and siren • Light elements with particularly long-lasting LEDs • Variety of colors: red, yellow, green, white or blue • Optimized illumination through improved prism technology with the 8WD44 • Acoustic elements can be adjusted in tone and volume • Extremely resistant to shock and vibrations • Easy connection and quick lamp change with secure bayonet mechanism • Communication capability through connection to AS-Interface 10/108 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 8WD42: The two-wire bus cable is fixed to the screw terminals in the connection element. The adapter element must be the first module to be positioned on the connection element. A maximum of 4 signaling elements can then be mounted on it. The 8WD42 28-0BB adapter element is a standard slave. 8WD44: The two-wire bus cable is fixed to the screw or spring-type terminals in the connection element. The adapter element must be the first module to be positioned on the connection element. The signaling elements can then be mounted on it. The 8WD44 28-0BE adapter element is a standard slave. A maximum of 4 signaling elements can be mounted on it. The 8WD44 28-0BD adapter element with A/B technology enables the connection of up to 62 slaves on one AS-Interface system. The addressing socket provides user-friendly parameterization of the AS-Interface elements. A maximum of 3 signaling elements can be mounted on it. © Siemens AG 2010 8WD4 Signaling Columns General data ■ Technical specifications Type 8WD42 8WD44 General data Approvals UL, CSA Light and acoustic elements Rated voltage, power consumption Light elements with incandescent lamp (AC values for 50/60 Hz) (AC values for 50/60 Hz) • Continuous light 12 V, 24 V, 115 V, 230 V AC/DC 12 V, 24 V, 115 V, 230 V AC/DC • Blinklight 24 V AC/DC/125 mA; 115 V AC/20 mA; 230 V AC/15 mA 24 V AC/DC/125 mA; 115 V AC/20 mA; 230 V AC/15 mA • Flashlights -- 24 V DC/125 mA; 115 V AC/20 mA; 230 V AC/35 mA • Max. inrush current, blinklight/flashlight -- 500 mA • Continuous light 24 V AC/DC/60 mA 24 V AC/DC/45 mA; 115 V AC/DC/25 mA; 230 V AC/25 mA • Blinklight -- 24 V AC/DC/40 mA • Rotating light -- 24 V AC/DC/70 mA • Buzzer element (tone: pulsating or continuous, 85 dB) 24 V AC/DC/25 mA; 115 V AC/DC/25 mA; 230 V AC/25 mA 24 V AC/DC/25 mA; 115 V AC/DC/25 mA; 230 V AC/25 mA • Siren element (8 tones + amplification can be set, 100 dB) -- 24 V AC/DC/80 mA; 115 V AC/30 mA; 230 V AC/16 mA • Siren element (108 dB) -- 24 V DC/100 mA GSM radio elements -- 24 V DC (controlled ±15%)/50 mA, transient 450 mA max. 5 – 7 2 4 × 106 flashes 4 × 106 flashes IO code/ID code 8/F 8/E Power supply • Operational voltage • Power consumption Imax Through bus cable 18.5 V ... 31.6 50 Through bus cable 18.5 V ... 31.6 100 Protective measures • Watchdog • Short-circuit/overload protection • Reverse polarity protection • Induction protection ✓ External back-up fuse M 1.6 A ✓ Does not apply ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ Outputs 4 Relay outputs 3 solid-state outputs • Load voltage V V External auxiliary voltage 0 ... 30 DC 0 ... 230 AC Through bus cable or external auxiliary voltage, switch-selectable • Current carrying capacity ∑ Imax - With external auxiliary voltage - Without external auxiliary voltage A A 1.5 -- 0.3 0.2 Operating temperature °C –20 ... +50 –20 ... +50 Enclosure material Thermoplast (polyamide), impact-resistant, black Thermoplast (polyamide), impact-resistant, black Light elements, GSM radio element Thermoplast (polycarbonate) Thermoplast (polycarbonate) ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ -✓ IP54 IP54 IP65 (seal premounted with every module) IP65 –20 ... +50 –20 ... +50 Light elements with integrated LED Acoustic elements Power consumption • Incandescent lamps, base BA 15d • Flashlight, flash energy W Ws Endurance • Flashlights V mA 10 AS-Interface adapter elements Enclosures Mounting • Horizontal (for floor mounting, foot with 25 mm Ø pipe) • Horizontal (single-hole mounting) • Vertical with bracket Degree of protection • Light elements • Acoustic elements, AS-i adapter elements Operating temperature °C Connection • Conductor cross-sections • Tightening torque M3 screw terminals mm2 Max. 2.5 Nm max. 0.5 Spring-type terminals/M3 screw terminals Max. 2.5 – / max. 0.5 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/109 © Siemens AG 2010 8WD4 Signaling Columns 8WD42 signaling columns, 50 mm diameter ■ Overview Features: • Thermoplast enclosure, diameter 50 mm • Degree of protection IP54 • Up to 4 elements can be mounted ■ Selection and ordering data Version Acoustic elements1) Rated voltage Color DT Order No. Price per PU PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG A 8WD4220-0FA 1 1 unit 102 A 8WD4240-0FA 1 1 unit 102 A 8WD4250-0FA 1 1 unit 102 102 V Buzzer elements 80 dB, 24 AC/DC pulsating or continuous tone, adjust- 115 AC able by means of a wire jumper 230 AC Black Light elements for incandescent lamps/LEDs, BA 15d bases2) Continuous light elements 24 ... 230 AC/DC Red A 8WD4200-1AB 1 1 unit Green A 8WD4200-1AC 1 1 unit 102 Yellow A 8WD4200-1AD 1 1 unit 102 Clear A 8WD4200-1AE 1 1 unit 102 Blue A 8WD4200-1AF 1 1 unit 102 102 Light elements with integrated LED Continuous light elements Blinklight elements 24 AC/DC 24 AC/DC 10 115 AC 230 AC Red A 8WD4220-5AB 1 1 unit Green A 8WD4220-5AC 1 1 unit 102 Yellow A 8WD4220-5AD 1 1 unit 102 Red A 8WD4220-5BB 1 1 unit 102 Green A 8WD4220-5BC 1 1 unit 102 Yellow A 8WD4220-5BD 1 1 unit 102 Clear A 8WD4220-5BE 1 1 unit 102 Blue A 8WD4220-5BF 1 1 unit 102 Red A 8WD4240-5BB 1 1 unit 102 Green A 8WD4240-5BC 1 1 unit 102 Yellow A 8WD4240-5BD 1 1 unit 102 Clear D 8WD4240-5BE 1 1 unit 102 Blue D 8WD4240-5BF 1 1 unit 102 Red A 8WD4250-5BB 1 1 unit 102 Green A 8WD4250-5BC 1 1 unit 102 Yellow A 8WD4250-5BD 1 1 unit 102 Clear A 8WD4250-5BE 1 1 unit 102 Blue A 8WD4250-5BF 1 1 unit 102 Black A 8WD4228-0BB 1 1 unit 102 Black A 8WD4208-0AA 1 1 unit 102 Adapter elements for AS-Interface AS-Interface adapter elements with external auxiliary voltage For 4 signaling elements 24 V DC Connection elements3) Connection elements with cover For mounting on pipes, floors and angles 1) The cover is included in the scope of supply of the acoustic elements and fixed in place. 2) The lamp is not included in the scope of supply. Please order separately. 3) The connection element with cover is an essential part for assembling the signaling columns. 10/110 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 Note: For mounting and configuring help see the publication "Versatile, robust, communication-capable: SIRIUS signaling columns and integrated signal lamps", Order No. E20001-A670-P305. * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate © Siemens AG 2010 8WD4 Signaling Columns 8WD42 signaling columns, 50 mm diameter Version Rated voltage Color DT Order No. Price per PU PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG V Lamps Incandescent lamps, 5 W Base BA 15d 24 AC/DC A 8WD4328-1XX 1 10 units 102 115 AC A 8WD4348-1XX 1 10 units 102 230 AC A 8WD4358-1XX 1 10 units 102 LEDs Base BA 15d 24 AC/DC Red Green Yellow Clear Blue A A A A A 8WD4428-6XB 8WD4428-6XC 8WD4428-6XD 8WD4428-6XE 8WD4428-6XF 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 115 AC Red Green Yellow Clear Blue A A A A A 8WD4448-6XB 8WD4448-6XC 8WD4448-6XD 8WD4448-6XE 8WD4448-6XF 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 230 AC Red Green Yellow Clear Blue A A A A A 8WD4458-6XB 8WD4458-6XC 8WD4458-6XD 8WD4458-6XE 8WD4458-6XF 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 Plastic, for mounting on pipes A 8WD4308-0DB 1 1 unit 102 Metal, for pipe lengths > 400 mm A 8WD4308-0DC 1 1 unit 102 Plastic, for floor mounting (without pipe) A 8WD4208-0DE 1 1 unit 102 8WD4408-0DF 1 1 unit 102 Feet, single Adjustable-angle feet Plastic, for mounting For positioning in 7.5° increments1) on pipes, incl. rubber seal Pipes, single Sockets for feet X Length 100 mm A 8WD4208-0EF 1 1 unit 102 Length 150 mm A 8WD4308-0EE 1 1 unit 102 Length 250 mm A 8WD4308-0EA 1 1 unit 102 Length 400 mm A 8WD4308-0EB 1 1 unit 102 Length 1000 mm A 8WD4308-0ED 1 1 unit 102 Side cable outlet A 8WD4308-0DD 1 1 unit 102 Side cable outlet, with magnetic fixing2) A 8WD4308-0DE 1 1 unit 102 A 8WD4408-0CC 1 1 unit 102 Brackets for mounting with foot Brackets for wall mounting (plastic) Mounting without feet and pipe A 8WD4208-0CD 1 1 unit 102 Adapters for single-hole mounting Mounting without feet and pipe, with M18 thread and fixing nut A 8WD4208-0EH 1 1 unit 102 For labeling panels, see 8WD44, page 10/114. 1) Markings for 30°, 45°, 60° and 90°. 2) For horizontal mounting, only 1 element is recommended. * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/111 10 Mounting © Siemens AG 2010 8WD4 Signaling Columns 8WD44 signaling columns, 70 mm diameter ■ Overview Features: • Thermoplast enclosure, diameter 70 mm • Advanced design and significantly improved illumination • Fast and flexible connection using spring-type terminals • Integrated degree of protection IP65 • Up to 5 elements can be mounted. ■ Selection and ordering data Version Acoustic elements1) Rated voltage Color PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG A 8WD4420-0FA 1 1 unit 102 A 8WD4440-0FA 1 1 unit 102 A 8WD4450-0FA 1 1 unit 102 A 8WD4420-0EA2 1 1 unit 102 115 AC A 8WD4440-0EA2 1 1 unit 102 230 AC A 8WD4450-0EA2 1 1 unit 102 A 8WD4420-0EA 1 1 unit 102 Black Siren elements, multi-tone, 100 dB, 8 tones and volume are adjustable Black 24 AC/DC Siren elements 108 dB, IP40 24 DC Continuous light elements 12 ... 230 AC/DC Light elements for incandescent lamps/LEDs, BA 15d bases2) 24 AC/DC 115 AC 10 230 AC Black Red A 8WD4400-1AB 1 1 unit 102 Green A 8WD4400-1AC 1 1 unit 102 Yellow A 8WD4400-1AD 1 1 unit 102 Clear A 8WD4400-1AE 1 1 unit 102 Blue A 8WD4400-1AF 1 1 unit 102 Red A 8WD4420-1BB 1 1 unit 102 Green A 8WD4420-1BC 1 1 unit 102 Yellow A 8WD4420-1BD 1 1 unit 102 Clear A 8WD4420-1BE 1 1 unit 102 Blue A 8WD4420-1BF 1 1 unit 102 Red A 8WD4440-1BB 1 1 unit 102 Green A 8WD4440-1BC 1 1 unit 102 Yellow A 8WD4440-1BD 1 1 unit 102 Clear A 8WD4440-1BE 1 1 unit 102 Blue A 8WD4440-1BF 1 1 unit 102 Red A 8WD4450-1BB 1 1 unit 102 Green A 8WD4450-1BC 1 1 unit 102 Yellow A 8WD4450-1BD 1 1 unit 102 Clear A 8WD4450-1BE 1 1 unit 102 Blue A 8WD4450-1BF 1 1 unit 102 Light elements with integrated flash lamps3) Flashlight elements with integrated 24 DC electronic flash 115 AC 230 AC 1) The cover is included in the scope of supply of the acoustic elements and fixed in place. 2) The lamp is not included in the scope of supply. Please order separately. 3) The lamp is included in the scope of supply. 10/112 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 Price per PU V Buzzer elements 85 dB, 24 AC/DC pulsating or continuous tone, adjust- 115 AC able by means of a wire jumper 230 AC Blinklight elements DT Order No. Red A 8WD4420-0CB 1 1 unit 102 Green A 8WD4420-0CC 1 1 unit 102 Yellow A 8WD4420-0CD 1 1 unit 102 Clear A 8WD4420-0CE 1 1 unit 102 Blue A 8WD4420-0CF 1 1 unit 102 Red A 8WD4440-0CB 1 1 unit 102 Green D 8WD4440-0CC 1 1 unit 102 Yellow A 8WD4440-0CD 1 1 unit 102 Clear D 8WD4440-0CE 1 1 unit 102 Blue D 8WD4440-0CF 1 1 unit 102 Red A 8WD4450-0CB 1 1 unit 102 Green A 8WD4450-0CC 1 1 unit 102 Yellow A 8WD4450-0CD 1 1 unit 102 Clear A 8WD4450-0CE 1 1 unit 102 Blue A 8WD4450-0CF 1 1 unit 102 * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate © Siemens AG 2010 8WD4 Signaling Columns 8WD44 signaling columns, 70 mm diameter Version Rated voltage Color DT Order No. Price per PU PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG V Light elements with integrated LED Continuous light elements 24 AC/DC 115 AC 230 AC Blinklight elements Rotating light elements 24 AC/DC 24 AC/DC Red A 8WD4420-5AB 1 1 unit 102 Green A 8WD4420-5AC 1 1 unit 102 Yellow A 8WD4420-5AD 1 1 unit 102 Clear A 8WD4420-5AE 1 1 unit 102 Blue A 8WD4420-5AF 1 1 unit 102 Red A 8WD4440-5AB 1 1 unit 102 Green A 8WD4440-5AC 1 1 unit 102 Yellow A 8WD4440-5AD 1 1 unit 102 Clear A 8WD4440-5AE 1 1 unit 102 Blue A 8WD4440-5AF 1 1 unit 102 Red A 8WD4450-5AB 1 1 unit 102 Green A 8WD4450-5AC 1 1 unit 102 Yellow A 8WD4450-5AD 1 1 unit 102 Clear A 8WD4450-5AE 1 1 unit 102 Blue A 8WD4450-5AF 1 1 unit 102 Red A 8WD4420-5BB 1 1 unit 102 Green A 8WD4420-5BC 1 1 unit 102 Yellow A 8WD4420-5BD 1 1 unit 102 Red A 8WD4420-5DB 1 1 unit 102 Green A 8WD4420-5DC 1 1 unit 102 Yellow A 8WD4420-5DD 1 1 unit 102 Adapter elements for AS-Interface AS-Interface adapter elements For 3 signaling elements 24 V DC Black A 8WD4428-0BD 1 1 unit 102 • Standard AS-Interface, with external auxiliary voltage For 4 signaling elements 24 V DC Black A 8WD4428-0BE 1 1 unit 102 • For mounting on pipes A 8WD4408-0AA 1 1 unit 102 • For mounting on bracket and floor A 8WD4408-0AB 1 1 unit 102 • For mounting on pipes A 8WD4408-0AD 1 1 unit 102 • For mounting on bracket and floor A 8WD4408-0AE 1 1 unit 102 24 AC/DC A 8WD4328-1XX 1 10 units 102 115 AC A 8WD4348-1XX 1 10 units 102 230 AC A 8WD4358-1XX 1 10 units 102 elements1) Connection elements with cover 10 Connection • A/B technology, with/without external auxiliary voltage, switchable Black Screw terminals Spring-type terminals Lamps Incandescent lamps, 5 W Base BA 15d LEDs Base BA 15d 1) 24 AC/DC Red Green Yellow Clear Blue A A A A A 8WD4428-6XB 8WD4428-6XC 8WD4428-6XD 8WD4428-6XE 8WD4428-6XF 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 115 AC Red Green Yellow Clear Blue A A A A A 8WD4448-6XB 8WD4448-6XC 8WD4448-6XD 8WD4448-6XE 8WD4448-6XF 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 230 AC Red Green Yellow Clear Blue A A A A A 8WD4458-6XB 8WD4458-6XC 8WD4458-6XD 8WD4458-6XE 8WD4458-6XF 1 1 1 1 1 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 102 102 102 102 102 The connection element with cover is an essential part for assembling the signaling columns. * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/113 © Siemens AG 2010 8WD4 Signaling Columns 8WD44 signaling columns, 70 mm diameter Version DT Order No. Price per PU PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG A 8WD4308-0DA 1 1 unit 102 Mounting Feet with pipe Feet, single Adjustable-angle feet For positioning in 7.5° increments1) Pipes, single Sockets for feet Plastic, for mounting on pipes A 8WD4308-0DB 1 1 unit 102 Metal, for pipe lengths > 400 mm A 8WD4308-0DC 1 1 unit 102 Plastic, for mounting on pipes, incl. rubber seal X 8WD4408-0DF 1 1 unit 102 Length 100 mm A 8WD4208-0EF 1 1 unit 102 Length 150 mm A 8WD4308-0EE 1 1 unit 102 Length 250 mm A 8WD4308-0EA 1 1 unit 102 Length 400 mm A 8WD4308-0EB 1 1 unit 102 Length 1000 mm A 8WD4308-0ED 1 1 unit 102 Side cable outlet (can also be used without feet) A 8WD4308-0DD 1 1 unit 102 Side cable outlet, with magnetic fixing2) A 8WD4308-0DE 1 1 unit 102 For single-sided mounting A 8WD4308-0CA 1 1 unit 102 For double-sided mounting A 8WD4308-0CB 1 1 unit 102 A 8WD4408-0CC 1 1 unit 102 10 Brackets for wall mounting (mounting without feet and pipe) Pipe length 100 mm Brackets for mounting with foot Brackets for base mounting Mounting without feet and pipe A 8WD4408-0CD 1 1 unit 102 Adapters for mounting on pipes according to NPT Mounting on pipes, ∅ 25 mm, with NPT 1/2" thread A 8WD4308-0DF 1 1 unit 102 A 8WD4408-0FA 1 1 unit 102 Inscriptions Labeling panels With fixing accessories for mounting on pipe ∅ 25 mm Inscription area/ step 50 mm x 140 mm Suitable for standard labels, e.g. • Zweckform 3425 • Herma 4457 1) Markings for 30°, 45°, 60° and 90°. 2) For horizontal mounting, only 1 element is recommended. 10/114 Siemens IC 10 · 2011 Note: For mounting and configuring help see the publication "Versatile, robust, communication-capable: SIRIUS signaling columns and integrated signal lamps", Order No. E20001-A670-P305. * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate © Siemens AG 2010 8WD5 Integrated Signal Lamps 8WD53 integrated signal lamps, 70 mm diameter ■ Overview Design Features: • Thermoplast enclosures, diameter 70 mm • Degree of protection IP65 • Rated voltage 24 V, 115 V, 230 V AC/DC • Ambient temperature -20 to +50 °C, incandescent lamp up to 60 °C The special shape of the integrated signal lamps means that the light is emitted optimally in every direction (to the sides and upwards). Continuous lights (with incandescent lamp or LED) and single-flash lights are available in five colors. The LED versions of the integrated signal lamps offer a considerably longer endurance than the incandescent lamp versions. All integrated signal lamps have a high degree of protection IP65 and are made of a material highly resistant to impact. Mounting Integrated signal lamps 8WD53 integrated signal lamps can be mounted directly at any point of the machine for the purpose of giving visual signals. They are mounted by means of a Pg 29 screw base with nut. ■ Selection and ordering data Version Rated voltage Color DT Order No. Price per PU PU (UNIT, SET, M) PS* PG Lights for incandescent lamps/LED, BA 15d base Continuous lights1) 24 ... 230 AC/DC Red A 8WD5300-1AB 1 1 unit 102 Green A 8WD5300-1AC 1 1 unit 102 Yellow A 8WD5300-1AD 1 1 unit 102 Clear A 8WD5300-1AE 1 1 unit 102 Blue A 8WD5300-1AF 1 1 unit 102 Single-flash lights with integrated electronic flash 24 AC/DC 115 AC 230 AC Red A 8WD5320-0CB 1 1 unit 102 Green D 8WD5320-0CC 1 1 unit 102 Yellow A 8WD5320-0CD 1 1 unit 102 Clear A 8WD5320-0CE 1 1 unit 102 Blue A 8WD5320-0CF 1 1 unit 102 Red A 8WD5340-0CB 1 1 unit 102 Green D 8WD5340-0CC 1 1 unit 102 Yellow D 8WD5340-0CD 1 1 unit 102 Clear D 8WD5340-0CE 1 1 unit 102 Blue D 8WD5340-0CF 1 1 unit 102 Red A 8WD5350-0CB 1 1 unit 102 Green D 8WD5350-0CC 1 1 unit 102 Yellow A 8WD5350-0CD 1 1 unit 102 Clear A 8WD5350-0CE 1 1 unit 102 Blue D 8WD5350-0CF 1 1 unit 102 Lights with integrated LED Continuous lights Blinklight lamps Rotating lights 24 AC/DC 24 AC/DC 24 AC/DC Red A 8WD5320-5AB 1 1 unit 102 Green A 8WD5320-5AC 1 1 unit 102 Yellow A 8WD5320-5AD 1 1 unit 102 Red A 8WD5320-5BB 1 1 unit 102 Green D 8WD5320-5BC 1 1 unit 102 Yellow A 8WD5320-5BD 1 1 unit 102 Red A 8WD5320-5DB 1 1 unit 102 Green A 8WD5320-5DC 1 1 unit 102 Yellow A 8WD5320-5DD 1 1 unit 102 For incandescent lamps and LEDs see Signaling Columns. 1) Lamp not included in scope of supply. Please order separately. * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2011 10/115 10 Lights with integrated flash lamp © Siemens AG 2010 8WD5 Integrated Signal Lamps 10 Notes 10/116 Siemens IC 10 · 2011